Provided by: mercurial-common_5.3.1-1ubuntu1_all bug

NAME

       hg - Mercurial source code management system

SYNOPSIS

       hg command [option]... [argument]...

DESCRIPTION

       The hg command provides a command line interface to the Mercurial system.

COMMAND ELEMENTS

       files...
              indicates  one or more filename or relative path filenames; see File Name Patterns for information
              on pattern matching

       path   indicates a path on the local machine

       revision
              indicates a changeset which can be specified as a changeset revision number, a tag,  or  a  unique
              substring of the changeset hash value

       repository path
              either the pathname of a local repository or the URI of a remote repository.

OPTIONS

       -R,--repository <REPO>
              repository root directory or name of overlay bundle file

       --cwd <DIR>
              change working directory

       -y, --noninteractive
              do not prompt, automatically pick the first choice for all prompts

       -q, --quiet
              suppress output

       -v, --verbose
              enable additional output

       --color <TYPE>
              when to colorize (boolean, always, auto, never, or debug)

       --config <CONFIG[+]>
              set/override config option (use 'section.name=value')

       --debug
              enable debugging output

       --debugger
              start debugger

       --encoding <ENCODE>
              set the charset encoding (default: UTF-8)

       --encodingmode <MODE>
              set the charset encoding mode (default: strict)

       --traceback
              always print a traceback on exception

       --time time how long the command takes

       --profile
              print command execution profile

       --version
              output version information and exit

       -h, --help
              display help and exit

       --hidden
              consider hidden changesets

       --pager <TYPE>
              when to paginate (boolean, always, auto, or never) (default: auto)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

COMMANDS

   Repository creation
   clone
       make a copy of an existing repository:

       hg clone [OPTION]... SOURCE [DEST]

       Create a copy of an existing repository in a new directory.

       If no destination directory name is specified, it defaults to the basename of the source.

       The  location of the source is added to the new repository's .hg/hgrc file, as the default to be used for
       future pulls.

       Only local paths and ssh:// URLs are supported as  destinations.  For  ssh://  destinations,  no  working
       directory or .hg/hgrc will be created on the remote side.

       If  the  source  repository  has  a bookmark called '@' set, that revision will be checked out in the new
       repository by default.

       To check out a particular version, use -u/--update, or -U/--noupdate to create a clone  with  no  working
       directory.

       To  pull only a subset of changesets, specify one or more revisions identifiers with -r/--rev or branches
       with -b/--branch. The resulting clone will contain only the specified  changesets  and  their  ancestors.
       These options (or 'clone src#rev dest') imply --pull, even for local source repositories.

       In  normal  clone  mode,  the  remote  normalizes  repository  data into a common exchange format and the
       receiving end translates this data into its local storage format. --stream activates  a  different  clone
       mode  that  essentially  copies  repository  files  from  the  remote  with minimal data processing. This
       significantly reduces the CPU cost of a clone both remotely and locally.  However, it often increases the
       transferred  data  size by 30-40%. This can result in substantially faster clones where I/O throughput is
       plentiful, especially for larger repositories. A side-effect of --stream clones is that storage  settings
       and  requirements  on  the  remote are applied locally: a modern client may inherit legacy or inefficient
       storage used by the remote or a legacy Mercurial client may not be able to clone from a modern  Mercurial
       remote.

       Note   Specifying a tag will include the tagged changeset but not the changeset containing the tag.

       For  efficiency,  hardlinks  are  used  for  cloning  whenever the source and destination are on the same
       filesystem (note this applies  only  to  the  repository  data,  not  to  the  working  directory).  Some
       filesystems,  such  as  AFS, implement hardlinking incorrectly, but do not report errors. In these cases,
       use the --pull option to avoid hardlinking.

       Mercurial will update the working directory to the first applicable revision from this list:

       a. null if -U or the source repository has no changesets

       b. if -u . and the source repository is local, the  first  parent  of  the  source  repository's  working
          directory

       c. the changeset specified with -u (if a branch name, this means the latest head of that branch)

       d. the changeset specified with -r

       e. the tipmost head specified with -b

       f. the tipmost head specified with the url#branch source syntax

       g. the revision marked with the '@' bookmark, if present

       h. the tipmost head of the default branch

       i. tip

       When   cloning   from   servers   that  support  it,  Mercurial  may  fetch  pre-generated  data  from  a
       server-advertised URL or inline from the same stream. When this is  done,  hooks  operating  on  incoming
       changesets  and  changegroups  may fire more than once, once for each pre-generated bundle and as well as
       for any additional remaining data. In addition, if an error occurs, the repository may be rolled back  to
       a partial clone. This behavior may change in future releases.  See hg help -e clonebundles for more.

       Examples:

       • clone a remote repository to a new directory named hg/:

         hg clone https://www.mercurial-scm.org/repo/hg/

       • create a lightweight local clone:

         hg clone project/ project-feature/

       • clone from an absolute path on an ssh server (note double-slash):

         hg clone ssh://user@server//home/projects/alpha/

       • do a streaming clone while checking out a specified version:

         hg clone --stream http://server/repo -u 1.5

       • create a repository without changesets after a particular revision:

         hg clone -r 04e544 experimental/ good/

       • clone (and track) a particular named branch:

         hg clone https://www.mercurial-scm.org/repo/hg/#stable

       See hg help urls for details on specifying URLs.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -U, --noupdate
              the clone will include an empty working directory (only a repository)

       -u,--updaterev <REV>
              revision, tag, or branch to check out

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              do not clone everything, but include this changeset and its ancestors

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              do not clone everything, but include this branch's changesets and their ancestors

       --pull use pull protocol to copy metadata

       --uncompressed
              an alias to --stream (DEPRECATED)

       --stream
              clone with minimal data processing

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   init
       create a new repository in the given directory:

       hg init [-e CMD] [--remotecmd CMD] [DEST]

       Initialize  a  new  repository  in the given directory. If the given directory does not exist, it will be
       created.

       If no directory is given, the current directory is used.

       It is possible to specify an ssh:// URL as the destination.  See hg help urls for more information.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

   Remote repository management
   incoming
       show new changesets found in source:

       hg incoming [-p] [-n] [-M] [-f] [-r REV]... [--bundle FILENAME] [SOURCE]

       Show new changesets found in the  specified  path/URL  or  the  default  pull  location.  These  are  the
       changesets that would have been pulled by hg pull at the time you issued this command.

       See pull for valid source format details.

       With  -B/--bookmarks,  the  result  of  bookmark  comparison  between  local  and  remote repositories is
       displayed. With -v/--verbose, status is also displayed for each bookmark like below:

       BM1               01234567890a added
       BM2               1234567890ab advanced
       BM3               234567890abc diverged
       BM4               34567890abcd changed

       The action taken locally when pulling depends on the status of each bookmark:

       added

              pull will create it

       advanced

              pull will update it

       diverged

              pull will create a divergent bookmark

       changed

              result depends on remote changesets

       From the point of view of pulling behavior, bookmark existing only in the remote repository  are  treated
       as added, even if it is in fact locally deleted.

       For remote repository, using --bundle avoids downloading the changesets twice if the incoming is followed
       by a pull.

       Examples:

       • show incoming changes with patches and full description:

         hg incoming -vp

       • show incoming changes excluding merges, store a bundle:

         hg in -vpM --bundle incoming.hg
         hg pull incoming.hg

       • briefly list changes inside a bundle:

         hg in changes.hg -T "{desc|firstline}\n"

       Returns 0 if there are incoming changes, 1 otherwise.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              run even if remote repository is unrelated

       -n, --newest-first
              show newest record first

       --bundle <FILE>
              file to store the bundles into

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a remote changeset intended to be added

       -B, --bookmarks
              compare bookmarks

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              a specific branch you would like to pull

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

       -M, --no-merges
              do not show merges

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       -G, --graph
              show the revision DAG

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: in

   outgoing
       show changesets not found in the destination:

       hg outgoing [-M] [-p] [-n] [-f] [-r REV]... [DEST]

       Show changesets not found in the specified destination repository or the default push location. These are
       the changesets that would be pushed if a push was requested.

       See pull for details of valid destination formats.

       With  -B/--bookmarks,  the  result  of  bookmark  comparison  between  local  and  remote repositories is
       displayed. With -v/--verbose, status is also displayed for each bookmark like below:

       BM1               01234567890a added
       BM2                            deleted
       BM3               234567890abc advanced
       BM4               34567890abcd diverged
       BM5               4567890abcde changed

       The action taken when pushing depends on the status of each bookmark:

       added

              push with -B will create it

       deleted

              push with -B will delete it

       advanced

              push will update it

       diverged

              push with -B will update it

       changed

              push with -B will update it

       From the point of view of pushing behavior, bookmarks existing only in the remote repository are  treated
       as deleted, even if it is in fact added remotely.

       Returns 0 if there are outgoing changes, 1 otherwise.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              run even when the destination is unrelated

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a changeset intended to be included in the destination

       -n, --newest-first
              show newest record first

       -B, --bookmarks
              compare bookmarks

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              a specific branch you would like to push

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

       -M, --no-merges
              do not show merges

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       -G, --graph
              show the revision DAG

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: out

   paths
       show aliases for remote repositories:

       hg paths [NAME]

       Show definition of symbolic path name NAME. If no name is given, show definition of all available names.

       Option  -q/--quiet  suppresses  all  output  when  searching  for NAME and shows only the path names when
       listing all definitions.

       Path names are defined in the [paths] section of your configuration file and in  /etc/mercurial/hgrc.  If
       run inside a repository, .hg/hgrc is used, too.

       The  path  names  default  and  default-push  have  a  special  meaning.   When performing a push or pull
       operation, they are used as fallbacks if no location is specified on the command-line.  When default-push
       is  set,  it  will  be  used for push and default will be used for pull; otherwise default is used as the
       fallback for both.  When cloning a repository, the clone source is written as default in .hg/hgrc.

       Note   default and default-push apply to all inbound (e.g.  hg incoming) and outbound (e.g. hg  outgoing,
              hg email and hg bundle) operations.

       See hg help urls for more information.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported. See also hg help templates.

       name   String. Symbolic name of the path alias.

       pushurl
              String. URL for push operations.

       url    String. URL or directory path for the other operations.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   pull
       pull changes from the specified source:

       hg pull [-u] [-f] [-r REV]... [-e CMD] [--remotecmd CMD] [SOURCE]

       Pull changes from a remote repository to a local one.

       This  finds  all  changes  from  the  repository  at  the  specified path or URL and adds them to a local
       repository (the current one unless -R is specified). By default, this does not update  the  copy  of  the
       project in the working directory.

       When  cloning  from  servers  that support it, Mercurial may fetch pre-generated data. When this is done,
       hooks operating on incoming  changesets  and  changegroups  may  fire  more  than  once,  once  for  each
       pre-generated  bundle  and  as well as for any additional remaining data. See hg help -e clonebundles for
       more.

       Use hg incoming if you want to see what would have been added by a pull  at  the  time  you  issued  this
       command.  If  you then decide to add those changes to the repository, you should use hg pull -r X where X
       is the last changeset listed by hg incoming.

       If SOURCE is omitted, the 'default' path will be used.  See hg help urls for more information.

       Specifying bookmark as . is equivalent to specifying the active bookmark's name.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if an update had unresolved files.

       Options:

       -u, --update
              update to new branch head if new descendants were pulled

       -f, --force
              run even when remote repository is unrelated

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a remote changeset intended to be added

       -B,--bookmark <BOOKMARK[+]>
              bookmark to pull

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              a specific branch you would like to pull

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   push
       push changes to the specified destination:

       hg push [-f] [-r REV]... [-e CMD] [--remotecmd CMD] [DEST]

       Push changesets from the local repository to the specified destination.

       This operation is symmetrical to pull: it is identical to a pull in the destination repository  from  the
       current one.

       By default, push will not allow creation of new heads at the destination, since multiple heads would make
       it unclear which head to use. In this situation, it is recommended to pull and merge before pushing.

       Use --new-branch if you want to allow push to create a new named  branch  that  is  not  present  at  the
       destination. This allows you to only create a new branch without forcing other changes.

       Note   Extra  care  should  be  taken  with  the  -f/--force option, which will push all new heads on all
              branches, an action which will almost always cause confusion for collaborators.

       If -r/--rev is used, the specified  revision  and  all  its  ancestors  will  be  pushed  to  the  remote
       repository.

       If  -B/--bookmark  is  used,  the  specified bookmarked revision, its ancestors, and the bookmark will be
       pushed to the remote repository. Specifying . is equivalent to specifying the active bookmark's name.

       Please see hg help urls for important details about ssh:// URLs. If DESTINATION  is  omitted,  a  default
       path will be used.

       The  --pushvars  option  sends  strings  to  the  server that become environment variables prepended with
       HG_USERVAR_.  For  example,  --pushvars  ENABLE_FEATURE=true,  provides  the  server  side   hooks   with
       HG_USERVAR_ENABLE_FEATURE=true as part of their environment.

       pushvars can provide for user-overridable hooks as well as set debug levels. One example is having a hook
       that blocks commits containing conflict markers, but enables the user to override the hook if the file is
       using  conflict  markers  for  testing  purposes  or  the file format has strings that look like conflict
       markers.

       By default, servers will ignore --pushvars. To enable it add the following to your configuration file:

       [push]
       pushvars.server = true

       Returns 0 if push was successful, 1 if nothing to push.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              force push

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a changeset intended to be included in the destination

       -B,--bookmark <BOOKMARK[+]>
              bookmark to push

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              a specific branch you would like to push

       --new-branch
              allow pushing a new branch

       --pushvars <VALUE[+]>
              variables that can be sent to server (ADVANCED)

       --publish
              push the changeset as public (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   serve
       start stand-alone webserver:

       hg serve [OPTION]...

       Start a local HTTP repository browser and pull server. You can use this for ad-hoc sharing  and  browsing
       of  repositories.  It is recommended to use a real web server to serve a repository for longer periods of
       time.

       Please note that the server does not implement access control.  This means that, by default, anybody  can
       read  from  the server and nobody can write to it by default. Set the web.allow-push option to * to allow
       everybody to push to the server. You should use a real web server if you need to authenticate users.

       By default, the server logs accesses  to  stdout  and  errors  to  stderr.  Use  the  -A/--accesslog  and
       -E/--errorlog options to log to files.

       To  have the server choose a free port number to listen on, specify a port number of 0; in this case, the
       server will print the port number it uses.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -A,--accesslog <FILE>
              name of access log file to write to

       -d, --daemon
              run server in background

       --daemon-postexec <VALUE[+]>
              used internally by daemon mode

       -E,--errorlog <FILE>
              name of error log file to write to

       -p,--port <PORT>
              port to listen on (default: 8000)

       -a,--address <ADDR>
              address to listen on (default: all interfaces)

       --prefix <PREFIX>
              prefix path to serve from (default: server root)

       -n,--name <NAME>
              name to show in web pages (default: working directory)

       --web-conf <FILE>
              name of the hgweb config file (see 'hg help hgweb')

       --webdir-conf <FILE>
              name of the hgweb config file (DEPRECATED)

       --pid-file <FILE>
              name of file to write process ID to

       --stdio
              for remote clients (ADVANCED)

       --cmdserver <MODE>
              for remote clients (ADVANCED)

       -t,--templates <TEMPLATE>
              web templates to use

       --style <STYLE>
              template style to use

       -6, --ipv6
              use IPv6 in addition to IPv4

       --certificate <FILE>
              SSL certificate file

       --print-url
              start and print only the URL

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   Change creation
   commit
       commit the specified files or all outstanding changes:

       hg commit [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Commit changes to the given files into the repository. Unlike a centralized  SCM,  this  operation  is  a
       local operation. See hg push for a way to actively distribute your changes.

       If a list of files is omitted, all changes reported by hg status will be committed.

       If you are committing the result of a merge, do not provide any filenames or -I/-X filters.

       If no commit message is specified, Mercurial starts your configured editor where you can enter a message.
       In case your commit fails, you will find a backup of your message in .hg/last-message.txt.

       The --close-branch flag can be used to mark the current branch head closed. When all heads  of  a  branch
       are closed, the branch will be considered closed and no longer listed.

       The --amend flag can be used to amend the parent of the working directory with a new commit that contains
       the changes in the parent in addition to those currently reported by hg status, if there are any. The old
       commit  is  stored in a backup bundle in .hg/strip-backup (see hg help bundle and hg help unbundle on how
       to restore it).

       Message, user and date are taken from the amended commit unless specified. When a message isn't specified
       on the command line, the editor will open with the message of the amended commit.

       It is not possible to amend public changesets (see hg help phases) or changesets that have children.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if nothing changed.

       Examples:

       • commit all files ending in .py:

         hg commit --include "set:**.py"

       • commit all non-binary files:

         hg commit --exclude "set:binary()"

       • amend the current commit and set the date to now:

         hg commit --amend --date now

       Options:

       -A, --addremove
              mark new/missing files as added/removed before committing

       --close-branch
              mark a branch head as closed

       --amend
              amend the parent of the working directory

       -s, --secret
              use the secret phase for committing

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       --force-close-branch
              forcibly close branch from a non-head changeset (ADVANCED)

       -i, --interactive
              use interactive mode

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: ci

   Change manipulation
   abort
       abort an unfinished operation (EXPERIMENTAL):

       hg abort

       Aborts  a  multistep  operation  like  graft,  histedit,  rebase,  merge,  and unshelve if they are in an
       unfinished state.

       use --dry-run/-n to dry run the command.

       Options:

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

   backout
       reverse effect of earlier changeset:

       hg backout [OPTION]... [-r] REV

       Prepare a new changeset with the effect of REV undone in the current working directory. If  no  conflicts
       were encountered, it will be committed immediately.

       If REV is the parent of the working directory, then this new changeset is committed automatically (unless
       --no-commit is specified).

       Note   hg backout cannot be used to fix either an unwanted or incorrect merge.

       Examples:

       • Reverse the effect of the parent of the working directory.  This backout will be committed immediately:

         hg backout -r .

       • Reverse the effect of previous bad revision 23:

         hg backout -r 23

       • Reverse the effect of previous bad revision 23 and leave changes uncommitted:

         hg backout -r 23 --no-commit
         hg commit -m "Backout revision 23"

       By default, the pending changeset will have one parent, maintaining a linear history. With  --merge,  the
       pending  changeset will instead have two parents: the old parent of the working directory and a new child
       of REV that simply undoes REV.

       Before version 1.7, the behavior without --merge was equivalent to  specifying  --merge  followed  by  hg
       update --clean . to cancel the merge and leave the child of REV as a head to be merged separately.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       See hg help revert for a way to restore files to the state of another revision.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if nothing to backout or there are unresolved files.

       Options:

       --merge
              merge with old dirstate parent after backout

       --commit
              commit if no conflicts were encountered (DEPRECATED)

       --no-commit
              do not commit

       --parent <REV>
              parent to choose when backing out merge (DEPRECATED)

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to backout

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -t,--tool <TOOL>
              specify merge tool

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   continue
       resumes an interrupted operation (EXPERIMENTAL):

       hg continue

       Finishes  a  multistep  operation  like  graft,  histedit,  rebase, merge, and unshelve if they are in an
       interrupted state.

       use --dry-run/-n to dry run the command.

       Options:

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

   graft
       copy changes from other branches onto the current branch:

       hg graft [OPTION]... [-r REV]... REV...

       This command uses Mercurial's merge logic to copy individual changes from other branches without  merging
       branches  in the history graph. This is sometimes known as 'backporting' or 'cherry-picking'. By default,
       graft will copy user, date, and description from the source changesets.

       Changesets that are ancestors of the current revision, that have already been grafted, or that are merges
       will be skipped.

       If --log is specified, log messages will have a comment appended of the form:

       (grafted from CHANGESETHASH)

       If  --force  is  specified, revisions will be grafted even if they are already ancestors of, or have been
       grafted to, the destination.  This is useful when the revisions have since been backed out.

       If a graft merge results in conflicts, the graft process is interrupted so that the current merge can  be
       manually  resolved.   Once  all  conflicts  are  addressed,  the  graft process can be continued with the
       -c/--continue option.

       The -c/--continue option reapplies all the earlier options.

       The --base option exposes more of how graft internally uses merge with a custom base revision. --base can
       be used to specify another ancestor than the first and only parent.

       The command:

       hg graft -r 345 --base 234

       is thus pretty much the same as:

       hg diff -r 234 -r 345 | hg import

       but using merge to resolve conflicts and track moved files.

       The result of a merge can thus be backported as a single commit by specifying one of the merge parents as
       base, and thus effectively grafting the changes from the other side.

       It is also possible to collapse multiple changesets and clean up history by specifying  another  ancestor
       as base, much like rebase --collapse --keep.

       The commit message can be tweaked after the fact using commit --amend .

       For  using  non-ancestors as the base to backout changes, see the backout command and the hidden --parent
       option.

       Examples:

       • copy a single change to the stable branch and edit its description:

         hg update stable
         hg graft --edit 9393

       • graft a range of changesets with one exception, updating dates:

         hg graft -D "2085::2093 and not 2091"

       • continue a graft after resolving conflicts:

         hg graft -c

       • show the source of a grafted changeset:

         hg log --debug -r .

       • show revisions sorted by date:

         hg log -r "sort(all(), date)"

       • backport the result of a merge as a single commit:

         hg graft -r 123 --base 123^

       • land a feature branch as one changeset:

         hg up -cr default
         hg graft -r featureX --base "ancestor('featureX', 'default')"

       See hg help revisions for more about specifying revisions.

       Returns 0 on successful completion.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revisions to graft

       --base <REV>
              base revision when doing the graft merge (ADVANCED)

       -c, --continue
              resume interrupted graft

       --stop stop interrupted graft

       --abort
              abort interrupted graft

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       --log  append graft info to log message

       --no-commit
              don't commit, just apply the changes in working directory

       -f, --force
              force graft

       -D, --currentdate
              record the current date as commit date

       -U, --currentuser
              record the current user as committer

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -t,--tool <TOOL>
              specify merge tool

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   merge
       merge another revision into working directory:

       hg merge [-P] [[-r] REV]

       The current working directory is updated with all changes made in the requested revision since  the  last
       common predecessor revision.

       Files  that  changed between either parent are marked as changed for the next commit and a commit must be
       performed before any further updates to the repository  are  allowed.  The  next  commit  will  have  two
       parents.

       --tool  can  be used to specify the merge tool used for file merges. It overrides the HGMERGE environment
       variable and your configuration files. See hg help merge-tools for options.

       If no revision is specified, the working directory's parent is a head revision, and  the  current  branch
       contains  exactly  one  other  head,  the  other  head  is merged with by default. Otherwise, an explicit
       revision with which to merge must be provided.

       See hg help resolve for information on handling file conflicts.

       To undo an uncommitted merge, use hg merge --abort which will check out a  clean  copy  of  the  original
       merge parent, losing all changes.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if there are unresolved files.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              force a merge including outstanding changes (DEPRECATED)

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to merge

       -P, --preview
              review revisions to merge (no merge is performed)

       --abort
              abort the ongoing merge

       -t,--tool <TOOL>
              specify merge tool

   Change organization
   bookmarks
       create a new bookmark or list existing bookmarks:

       hg bookmarks [OPTIONS]... [NAME]...

       Bookmarks are labels on changesets to help track lines of development.  Bookmarks are unversioned and can
       be moved, renamed and deleted.  Deleting or moving a bookmark has no effect on the associated changesets.

       Creating or updating to a bookmark causes it to be marked as 'active'.  The active bookmark is  indicated
       with  a  '*'.   When  a  commit  is made, the active bookmark will advance to the new commit.  A plain hg
       update will also advance an active bookmark, if possible.  Updating away from a bookmark will cause it to
       be deactivated.

       Bookmarks  can be pushed and pulled between repositories (see hg help push and hg help pull). If a shared
       bookmark has diverged, a new 'divergent bookmark' of the form 'name@path' will be created. Using hg merge
       will resolve the divergence.

       Specifying bookmark as '.' to -m/-d/-l options is equivalent to specifying the active bookmark's name.

       A bookmark named '@' has the special property that hg clone will check it out by default if it exists.

       Template:

       The  following  keywords  are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions such as
       {bookmark}. See also hg help templates.

       active Boolean. True if the bookmark is active.

       Examples:

       • create an active bookmark for a new line of development:

         hg book new-feature

       • create an inactive bookmark as a place marker:

         hg book -i reviewed

       • create an inactive bookmark on another changeset:

         hg book -r .^ tested

       • rename bookmark turkey to dinner:

         hg book -m turkey dinner

       • move the '@' bookmark from another branch:

         hg book -f @

       • print only the active bookmark name:

         hg book -ql .

       Options:

       -f, --force
              force

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision for bookmark action

       -d, --delete
              delete a given bookmark

       -m,--rename <OLD>
              rename a given bookmark

       -i, --inactive
              mark a bookmark inactive

       -l, --list
              list existing bookmarks

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

              aliases: bookmark

   branch
       set or show the current branch name:

       hg branch [-fC] [NAME]

       Note   Branch names are permanent and global. Use hg bookmark to create a light-weight bookmark  instead.
              See hg help glossary for more information about named branches and bookmarks.

       With  no argument, show the current branch name. With one argument, set the working directory branch name
       (the branch will not exist in the repository until the next commit). Standard  practice  recommends  that
       primary development take place on the 'default' branch.

       Unless -f/--force is specified, branch will not let you set a branch name that already exists.

       Use  -C/--clean  to  reset  the  working directory branch to that of the parent of the working directory,
       negating a previous branch change.

       Use the command hg update to switch to an existing branch. Use  hg  commit  --close-branch to  mark  this
       branch head as closed.  When all heads of a branch are closed, the branch will be considered closed.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              set branch name even if it shadows an existing branch

       -C, --clean
              reset branch name to parent branch name

       -r,--rev <VALUE[+]>
              change branches of the given revs (EXPERIMENTAL)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   branches
       list repository named branches:

       hg branches [-c]

       List  the  repository's  named branches, indicating which ones are inactive. If -c/--closed is specified,
       also list branches which have been marked closed (see hg commit --close-branch).

       Use the command hg update to switch to an existing branch.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and  functions  such  as
       {branch}. See also hg help templates.

       active Boolean. True if the branch is active.

       closed Boolean. True if the branch is closed.

       current
              Boolean. True if it is the current branch.

       Returns 0.

       Options:

       -a, --active
              show only branches that have unmerged heads (DEPRECATED)

       -c, --closed
              show normal and closed branches

       -r,--rev <VALUE[+]>
              show branch name(s) of the given rev

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   phase
       set or show the current phase name:

       hg phase [-p|-d|-s] [-f] [-r] [REV...]

       With no argument, show the phase name of the current revision(s).

       With one of -p/--public, -d/--draft or -s/--secret, change the phase value of the specified revisions.

       Unless  -f/--force  is  specified,  hg  phase won't move changesets from a lower phase to a higher phase.
       Phases are ordered as follows:

       public < draft < secret

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if some phases could not be changed.

       (For more information about the phases concept, see hg help phases.)

       Options:

       -p, --public
              set changeset phase to public

       -d, --draft
              set changeset phase to draft

       -s, --secret
              set changeset phase to secret

       -f, --force
              allow to move boundary backward

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              target revision

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   tag
       add one or more tags for the current or given revision:

       hg tag [-f] [-l] [-m TEXT] [-d DATE] [-u USER] [-r REV] NAME...

       Name a particular revision using <name>.

       Tags are used to name particular revisions of the repository and are very  useful  to  compare  different
       revisions, to go back to significant earlier versions or to mark branch points as releases, etc. Changing
       an existing tag is normally disallowed; use -f/--force to override.

       If no revision is given, the parent of the working directory is used.

       To facilitate version control, distribution, and merging of  tags,  they  are  stored  as  a  file  named
       ".hgtags"  which  is  managed  similarly to other project files and can be hand-edited if necessary. This
       also means that tagging creates a new commit. The file ".hg/localtags" is used for local tags (not shared
       among repositories).

       Tag  commits  are  usually  made at the head of a branch. If the parent of the working directory is not a
       branch head, hg tag aborts; use -f/--force to force the tag commit to be based on a non-head changeset.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Since tag names have priority over branch names during revision lookup, using an existing branch name  as
       a tag name is discouraged.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              force tag

       -l, --local
              make the tag local

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to tag

       --remove
              remove a tag

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

   tags
       list repository tags:

       hg tags

       This  lists  both regular and local tags. When the -v/--verbose switch is used, a third column "local" is
       printed for local tags.  When the -q/--quiet switch is used, only the tag name is printed.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and  functions  such  as
       {tag}. See also hg help templates.

       type   String. local for local tags.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   File content management
   annotate
       show changeset information by line for each file:

       hg annotate [-r REV] [-f] [-a] [-u] [-d] [-n] [-c] [-l] FILE...

       List changes in files, showing the revision id responsible for each line.

       This command is useful for discovering when a change was made and by whom.

       If  you  include  --file,  --user,  or  --date, the revision number is suppressed unless you also include
       --number.

       Without the -a/--text option, annotate will avoid  processing  files  it  detects  as  binary.  With  -a,
       annotate  will  annotate  the  file  anyway,  although  the  results  will probably be neither useful nor
       desirable.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See  also
       hg help templates.

       lines  List of lines with annotation data.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the specified file.

       And  each  entry  of  {lines}  provides  the following sub-keywords in addition to {date}, {node}, {rev},
       {user}, etc.

       line   String. Line content.

       lineno Integer. Line number at that revision.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file at that revision.

       See hg help templates.operators for the list expansion syntax.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              annotate the specified revision

       --follow
              follow copies/renames and list the filename (DEPRECATED)

       --no-follow
              don't follow copies and renames

       -a, --text
              treat all files as text

       -u, --user
              list the author (long with -v)

       -f, --file
              list the filename

       -d, --date
              list the date (short with -q)

       -n, --number
              list the revision number (default)

       -c, --changeset
              list the changeset

       -l, --line-number
              show line number at the first appearance

       --skip <REV[+]>
              revset to not display (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -w, --ignore-all-space
              ignore white space when comparing lines

       -b, --ignore-space-change
              ignore changes in the amount of white space

       -B, --ignore-blank-lines
              ignore changes whose lines are all blank

       -Z, --ignore-space-at-eol
              ignore changes in whitespace at EOL

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: blame

   cat
       output the current or given revision of files:

       hg cat [OPTION]... FILE...

       Print the specified files as they were at the given revision. If no revision is given, the parent of  the
       working directory is used.

       Output may be to a file, in which case the name of the file is given using a template string. See hg help
       templates. In addition to the common template keywords, the following formatting rules are supported:

       %%

              literal "%" character

       %s

              basename of file being printed

       %d

              dirname of file being printed, or '.' if in repository root

       %p

              root-relative path name of file being printed

       %H

              changeset hash (40 hexadecimal digits)

       %R

              changeset revision number

       %h

              short-form changeset hash (12 hexadecimal digits)

       %r

              zero-padded changeset revision number

       %b

              basename of the exporting repository

       \

              literal "" character

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See  also
       hg help templates.

       data   String. File content.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -o,--output <FORMAT>
              print output to file with formatted name

       -r,--rev <REV>
              print the given revision

       --decode
              apply any matching decode filter

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   copy
       mark files as copied for the next commit:

       hg copy [OPTION]... SOURCE... DEST

       Mark  dest as having copies of source files. If dest is a directory, copies are put in that directory. If
       dest is a file, the source must be a single file.

       By default, this command copies the contents of files as they exist in the working directory. If  invoked
       with -A/--after, the operation is recorded, but no copying is performed.

       This command takes effect with the next commit. To undo a copy before that, see hg revert.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if errors are encountered.

       Options:

       -A, --after
              record a copy that has already occurred

       -f, --force
              forcibly copy over an existing managed file

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: cp

   diff
       diff repository (or selected files):

       hg diff [OPTION]... ([-c REV] | [-r REV1 [-r REV2]]) [FILE]...

       Show differences between revisions for the specified files.

       Differences between files are shown using the unified diff format.

       Note   hg  diff may  generate  unexpected results for merges, as it will default to comparing against the
              working directory's first parent changeset if no revisions are specified.

       When two revision arguments are given, then changes are  shown  between  those  revisions.  If  only  one
       revision is specified then that revision is compared to the working directory, and, when no revisions are
       specified, the working directory files are compared to its first parent.

       Alternatively you can specify -c/--change with a revision to see the changes in that  changeset  relative
       to its first parent.

       Without  the  -a/--text  option, diff will avoid generating diffs of files it detects as binary. With -a,
       diff will generate a diff anyway, probably with undesirable results.

       Use the -g/--git option to generate diffs in the git extended diff format. For more information, read  hg
       help diffs.

       Examples:

       • compare a file in the current working directory to its parent:

         hg diff foo.c

       • compare two historical versions of a directory, with rename info:

         hg diff --git -r 1.0:1.2 lib/

       • get change stats relative to the last change on some date:

         hg diff --stat -r "date('may 2')"

       • diff all newly-added files that contain a keyword:

         hg diff "set:added() and grep(GNU)"

       • compare a revision and its parents:

         hg diff -c 9353         # compare against first parent
         hg diff -r 9353^:9353   # same using revset syntax
         hg diff -r 9353^2:9353  # compare against the second parent

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revision

       -c,--change <REV>
              change made by revision

       -a, --text
              treat all files as text

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       --binary
              generate binary diffs in git mode (default)

       --nodates
              omit dates from diff headers

       --noprefix
              omit a/ and b/ prefixes from filenames

       -p, --show-function
              show which function each change is in

       --reverse
              produce a diff that undoes the changes

       -w, --ignore-all-space
              ignore white space when comparing lines

       -b, --ignore-space-change
              ignore changes in the amount of white space

       -B, --ignore-blank-lines
              ignore changes whose lines are all blank

       -Z, --ignore-space-at-eol
              ignore changes in whitespace at EOL

       -U,--unified <NUM>
              number of lines of context to show

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       --root <DIR>
              produce diffs relative to subdirectory

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   grep
       search for a pattern in specified files:

       hg grep [--diff] [OPTION]... PATTERN [FILE]...

       Search  the working directory or revision history for a regular expression in the specified files for the
       entire repository.

       By default, grep searches the repository files in the working directory and prints  the  files  where  it
       finds a match. To specify historical revisions instead of the working directory, use the --rev flag.

       To search instead historical revision differences that contains a change in match status ("-" for a match
       that becomes a non-match, or "+" for a non-match that becomes a match), use the --diff flag.

       PATTERN can be any Python (roughly Perl-compatible) regular expression.

       If no FILEs are specified and the --rev flag isn't supplied, all  files  in  the  working  directory  are
       searched.  When  using  the --rev flag and specifying FILEs, use the --follow argument to also follow the
       specified FILEs across renames and copies.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See  also
       hg help templates.

       change String. Character denoting insertion + or removal -.  Available if --diff is specified.

       lineno Integer. Line number of the match.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file.

       texts  List of text chunks.

       And each entry of {texts} provides the following sub-keywords.

       matched
              Boolean. True if the chunk matches the specified pattern.

       text   String. Chunk content.

       See hg help templates.operators for the list expansion syntax.

       Returns 0 if a match is found, 1 otherwise.

       Options:

       -0, --print0
              end fields with NUL

       --all  print all revisions that match (DEPRECATED)

       --diff search revision differences for when the pattern was added or removed

       -a, --text
              treat all files as text

       -f, --follow
              follow changeset history, or file history across copies and renames

       -i, --ignore-case
              ignore case when matching

       -l, --files-with-matches
              print only filenames and revisions that match

       -n, --line-number
              print matching line numbers

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              search files changed within revision range

       --all-files
              include all files in the changeset while grepping (DEPRECATED)

       -u, --user
              list the author (long with -v)

       -d, --date
              list the date (short with -q)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   Change navigation
   bisect
       subdivision search of changesets:

       hg bisect [-gbsr] [-U] [-c CMD] [REV]

       This  command  helps to find changesets which introduce problems. To use, mark the earliest changeset you
       know exhibits the problem as bad, then mark the latest changeset which is free from the problem as  good.
       Bisect  will  update your working directory to a revision for testing (unless the -U/--noupdate option is
       specified). Once you have performed tests, mark the working directory as good or  bad,  and  bisect  will
       either update to another candidate changeset or announce that it has found the bad revision.

       As  a shortcut, you can also use the revision argument to mark a revision as good or bad without checking
       it out first.

       If you supply a command, it will be used for automatic bisection.  The environment variable HG_NODE  will
       contain  the  ID  of  the  changeset  being  tested.  The exit status of the command will be used to mark
       revisions as good or bad: status 0 means good, 125 means to skip the revision, 127  (command  not  found)
       will abort the bisection, and any other non-zero exit status means the revision is bad.

       Some examples:

       • start a bisection with known bad revision 34, and good revision 12:

         hg bisect --bad 34
         hg bisect --good 12

       • advance the current bisection by marking current revision as good or bad:

         hg bisect --good
         hg bisect --bad

       • mark  the  current  revision,  or  a known revision, to be skipped (e.g. if that revision is not usable
         because of another issue):

         hg bisect --skip
         hg bisect --skip 23

       • skip all revisions that do not touch directories foo or bar:

         hg bisect --skip "!( file('path:foo') & file('path:bar') )"

       • forget the current bisection:

         hg bisect --reset

       • use 'make && make tests' to automatically find the first broken revision:

         hg bisect --reset
         hg bisect --bad 34
         hg bisect --good 12
         hg bisect --command "make && make tests"

       • see all changesets whose states are already known in the current bisection:

         hg log -r "bisect(pruned)"

       • see the changeset currently being bisected (especially useful if running with -U/--noupdate):

         hg log -r "bisect(current)"

       • see all changesets that took part in the current bisection:

         hg log -r "bisect(range)"

       • you can even get a nice graph:

         hg log --graph -r "bisect(range)"

       See hg help revisions.bisect for more about the bisect() predicate.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r, --reset
              reset bisect state

       -g, --good
              mark changeset good

       -b, --bad
              mark changeset bad

       -s, --skip
              skip testing changeset

       -e, --extend
              extend the bisect range

       -c,--command <CMD>
              use command to check changeset state

       -U, --noupdate
              do not update to target

   heads
       show branch heads:

       hg heads [-ct] [-r STARTREV] [REV]...

       With no arguments, show all open branch heads in the repository.  Branch heads are changesets  that  have
       no  descendants  on  the  same branch. They are where development generally takes place and are the usual
       targets for update and merge operations.

       If one or more REVs are given, only open branch heads on  the  branches  associated  with  the  specified
       changesets  are  shown.  This  means  that  you  can  use  hg  heads  . to see the heads on the currently
       checked-out branch.

       If -c/--closed is specified, also show branch heads marked closed (see hg commit --close-branch).

       If STARTREV is specified, only those heads that are descendants of STARTREV will be displayed.

       If -t/--topo is specified, named branch mechanics will be ignored and only topological heads  (changesets
       with no children) will be shown.

       Returns 0 if matching heads are found, 1 if not.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <STARTREV>
              show only heads which are descendants of STARTREV

       -t, --topo
              show topological heads only

       -a, --active
              show active branchheads only (DEPRECATED)

       -c, --closed
              show normal and closed branch heads

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   identify
       identify the working directory or specified revision:

       hg identify [-nibtB] [-r REV] [SOURCE]

       Print  a  summary  identifying  the  repository  state  at  REV using one or two parent hash identifiers,
       followed by a "+" if the working directory has uncommitted changes, the branch name (if not  default),  a
       list of tags, and a list of bookmarks.

       When  REV  is  not  given,  print  a summary of the current state of the repository including the working
       directory. Specify -r. to get information of the working directory parent  without  scanning  uncommitted
       changes.

       Specifying  a  path  to  a  repository  root  or  Mercurial  bundle  will cause lookup to operate on that
       repository/bundle.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See  also
       hg help templates.

       dirty  String. Character + denoting if the working directory has uncommitted changes.

       id     String. One or two nodes, optionally followed by +.

       parents
              List of strings. Parent nodes of the changeset.

       Examples:

       • generate a build identifier for the working directory:

         hg id --id > build-id.dat

       • find the revision corresponding to a tag:

         hg id -n -r 1.3

       • check the most recent revision of a remote repository:

         hg id -r tip https://www.mercurial-scm.org/repo/hg/

       See hg log for generating more information about specific revisions, including full hash identifiers.

       Returns 0 if successful.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              identify the specified revision

       -n, --num
              show local revision number

       -i, --id
              show global revision id

       -b, --branch
              show branch

       -t, --tags
              show tags

       -B, --bookmarks
              show bookmarks

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

              aliases: id

   log
       show revision history of entire repository or files:

       hg log [OPTION]... [FILE]

       Print the revision history of the specified files or the entire project.

       If no revision range is specified, the default is tip:0 unless --follow is set, in which case the working
       directory parent is used as the starting revision.

       File history is shown without following rename or copy history of files. Use -f/--follow with a  filename
       to  follow history across renames and copies. --follow without a filename will only show ancestors of the
       starting revision.

       By default this command prints revision number and changeset id, tags, non-trivial  parents,  user,  date
       and  time, and a summary for each commit. When the -v/--verbose switch is used, the list of changed files
       and full commit message are shown.

       With --graph the revisions are shown as an ASCII art DAG with the most recent changeset at the top.   'o'
       is a changeset, '@' is a working directory parent, '_' closes a branch, 'x' is obsolete, '*' is unstable,
       and '+' represents a fork where the changeset from the lines below is a parent of the 'o'  merge  on  the
       same  line.  Paths in the DAG are represented with '|', '/' and so forth. ':' in place of a '|' indicates
       one or more revisions in a path are omitted.

       Use -L/--line-range FILE,M:N options to follow the history of lines from M to N in FILE. With  -p/--patch
       only  diff  hunks  affecting specified line range will be shown. This option requires --follow; it can be
       specified multiple times. Currently,  this  option  is  not  compatible  with  --graph.  This  option  is
       experimental.

       Note   hg  log  --patch may generate unexpected diff output for merge changesets, as it will only compare
              the merge changeset against its first parent. Also, only files different from  BOTH  parents  will
              appear in files:.

       Note   For performance reasons, hg log FILE may omit duplicate changes made on branches and will not show
              removals or mode changes. To see all such changes, use the --removed switch.

       Note   The history resulting from -L/--line-range options  depends  on  diff  options;  for  instance  if
              white-spaces  are  ignored, respective changes with only white-spaces in specified line range will
              not be listed.

       Some examples:

       • changesets with full descriptions and file lists:

         hg log -v

       • changesets ancestral to the working directory:

         hg log -f

       • last 10 commits on the current branch:

         hg log -l 10 -b .

       • changesets showing all modifications of a file, including removals:

         hg log --removed file.c

       • all changesets that touch a directory, with diffs, excluding merges:

         hg log -Mp lib/

       • all revision numbers that match a keyword:

         hg log -k bug --template "{rev}\n"

       • the full hash identifier of the working directory parent:

         hg log -r . --template "{node}\n"

       • list available log templates:

         hg log -T list

       • check if a given changeset is included in a tagged release:

         hg log -r "a21ccf and ancestor(1.9)"

       • find all changesets by some user in a date range:

         hg log -k alice -d "may 2008 to jul 2008"

       • summary of all changesets after the last tag:

         hg log -r "last(tagged())::" --template "{desc|firstline}\n"

       • changesets touching lines 13 to 23 for file.c:

         hg log -L file.c,13:23

       • changesets touching lines 13 to 23 for file.c and lines 2 to 6 of main.c with patch:

         hg log -L file.c,13:23 -L main.c,2:6 -p

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       See hg help revisions for more about specifying and ordering revisions.

       See hg help templates for more about pre-packaged styles and specifying  custom  templates.  The  default
       template used by the log command can be customized via the ui.logtemplate configuration setting.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -f, --follow
              follow changeset history, or file history across copies and renames

       --follow-first
              only follow the first parent of merge changesets (DEPRECATED)

       -d,--date <DATE>
              show revisions matching date spec

       -C, --copies
              show copied files

       -k,--keyword <TEXT[+]>
              do case-insensitive search for a given text

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              show the specified revision or revset

       -L,--line-range <FILE,RANGE[+]>
              follow line range of specified file (EXPERIMENTAL)

       --removed
              include revisions where files were removed

       -m, --only-merges
              show only merges (DEPRECATED) (use -r "merge()" instead)

       -u,--user <USER[+]>
              revisions committed by user

       --only-branch <BRANCH[+]>
              show only changesets within the given named branch (DEPRECATED)

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              show changesets within the given named branch

       -P,--prune <REV[+]>
              do not display revision or any of its ancestors

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

       -M, --no-merges
              do not show merges

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       -G, --graph
              show the revision DAG

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: history

   parents
       show the parents of the working directory or revision (DEPRECATED):

       hg parents [-r REV] [FILE]

       Print  the  working directory's parent revisions. If a revision is given via -r/--rev, the parent of that
       revision will be printed.  If a file argument is given, the revision in which the file was  last  changed
       (before the working directory revision or the argument to --rev if given) is printed.

       This command is equivalent to:

       hg log -r "p1()+p2()" or
       hg log -r "p1(REV)+p2(REV)" or
       hg log -r "max(::p1() and file(FILE))+max(::p2() and file(FILE))" or
       hg log -r "max(::p1(REV) and file(FILE))+max(::p2(REV) and file(FILE))"

       See hg summary and hg help revsets for related information.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              show parents of the specified revision

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   tip
       show the tip revision (DEPRECATED):

       hg tip [-p] [-g]

       The  tip  revision  (usually  just called the tip) is the changeset most recently added to the repository
       (and therefore the most recently changed head).

       If you have just made a commit, that commit will be the tip. If you have just pulled changes from another
       repository,  the  tip  of that repository becomes the current tip. The "tip" tag is special and cannot be
       renamed or assigned to a different changeset.

       This command is deprecated, please use hg heads instead.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   Working directory management
   add
       add the specified files on the next commit:

       hg add [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Schedule files to be version controlled and added to the repository.

       The files will be added to the repository at the next commit. To undo an add before that, see hg forget.

       If no names are given, add all files to the repository (except files matching .hgignore).

       Examples:

          • New (unknown) files are added automatically by hg add:

            $ ls
            foo.c
            $ hg status
            ? foo.c
            $ hg add
            adding foo.c
            $ hg status
            A foo.c

          • Specific files to be added can be specified:

            $ ls
            bar.c  foo.c
            $ hg status
            ? bar.c
            ? foo.c
            $ hg add bar.c
            $ hg status
            A bar.c
            ? foo.c

       Returns 0 if all files are successfully added.

       Options:

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   addremove
       add all new files, delete all missing files:

       hg addremove [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Add all new files and remove all missing files from the repository.

       Unless names are given, new files are ignored if they match any of the patterns  in  .hgignore.  As  with
       add, these changes take effect at the next commit.

       Use  the  -s/--similarity  option  to  detect  renamed  files.  This  option takes a percentage between 0
       (disabled) and 100 (files must be identical) as its parameter. With a  parameter  greater  than  0,  this
       compares  every removed file with every added file and records those similar enough as renames. Detecting
       renamed files this way can be expensive. After using this option, hg status -C can be used to check which
       files  were  identified  as  moved or renamed. If not specified, -s/--similarity defaults to 100 and only
       renames of identical files are detected.

       Examples:

          • A number of files (bar.c and foo.c) are new, while foobar.c  has  been  removed  (without  using  hg
            remove) from the repository:

            $ ls
            bar.c foo.c
            $ hg status
            ! foobar.c
            ? bar.c
            ? foo.c
            $ hg addremove
            adding bar.c
            adding foo.c
            removing foobar.c
            $ hg status
            A bar.c
            A foo.c
            R foobar.c

          • A file foobar.c was moved to foo.c without using hg rename.  Afterwards, it was edited slightly:

            $ ls
            foo.c
            $ hg status
            ! foobar.c
            ? foo.c
            $ hg addremove --similarity 90
            removing foobar.c
            adding foo.c
            recording removal of foobar.c as rename to foo.c (94% similar)
            $ hg status -C
            A foo.c
              foobar.c
            R foobar.c

       Returns 0 if all files are successfully added.

       Options:

       -s,--similarity <SIMILARITY>
              guess renamed files by similarity (0<=s<=100)

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   files
       list tracked files:

       hg files [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Print  files  under  Mercurial  control  in  the  working directory or specified revision for given files
       (excluding removed files).  Files can be specified as filenames or filesets.

       If no files are given to match, this command prints the names of all files under Mercurial control.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See  also
       hg help templates.

       flags  String. Character denoting file's symlink and executable bits.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file.

       size   Integer. Size of the file in bytes.

       Examples:

       • list all files under the current directory:

         hg files .

       • shows sizes and flags for current revision:

         hg files -vr .

       • list all files named README:

         hg files -I "**/README"

       • list all binary files:

         hg files "set:binary()"

       • find files containing a regular expression:

         hg files "set:grep('bob')"

       • search tracked file contents with xargs and grep:

         hg files -0 | xargs -0 grep foo

       See hg help patterns and hg help filesets for more information on specifying file patterns.

       Returns 0 if a match is found, 1 otherwise.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              search the repository as it is in REV

       -0, --print0
              end filenames with NUL, for use with xargs

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   forget
       forget the specified files on the next commit:

       hg forget [OPTION]... FILE...

       Mark the specified files so they will no longer be tracked after the next commit.

       This  only  removes  files  from the current branch, not from the entire project history, and it does not
       delete them from the working directory.

       To delete the file from the working directory, see hg remove.

       To undo a forget before the next commit, see hg add.

       Examples:

       • forget newly-added binary files:

         hg forget "set:added() and binary()"

       • forget files that would be excluded by .hgignore:

         hg forget "set:hgignore()"

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -i, --interactive
              use interactive mode

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   locate
       locate files matching specific patterns (DEPRECATED):

       hg locate [OPTION]... [PATTERN]...

       Print files under Mercurial control in the working directory whose names match the given patterns.

       By default, this command searches all directories in the working directory. To search  just  the  current
       directory and its subdirectories, use "--include .".

       If  no patterns are given to match, this command prints the names of all files under Mercurial control in
       the working directory.

       If you want to feed the output of this command into the "xargs" command, use the -0 option to  both  this
       command  and  "xargs".  This  will  avoid  the  problem of "xargs" treating single filenames that contain
       whitespace as multiple filenames.

       See hg help files for a more versatile command.

       Returns 0 if a match is found, 1 otherwise.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              search the repository as it is in REV

       -0, --print0
              end filenames with NUL, for use with xargs

       -f, --fullpath
              print complete paths from the filesystem root

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   remove
       remove the specified files on the next commit:

       hg remove [OPTION]... FILE...

       Schedule the indicated files for removal from the current branch.

       This command schedules the files to be removed at the next commit.  To undo a remove before that, see  hg
       revert. To undo added files, see hg forget.

       -A/--after  can  be  used  to remove only files that have already been deleted, -f/--force can be used to
       force deletion, and -Af can be used to remove files from the next revision without deleting them from the
       working directory.

       The  following  table  details  the  behavior  of  remove  for different file states (columns) and option
       combinations (rows). The file states are Added [A], Clean [C], Modified [M] and Missing [!]  (as reported
       by hg status). The actions are Warn, Remove (from branch) and Delete (from disk):

                                             ┌──────────┬───┬────┬────┬───┐
                                             │opt/state │ A │ C  │ M  │ ! │
                                             ├──────────┼───┼────┼────┼───┤
                                             │none      │ W │ RD │ W  │ R │
                                             ├──────────┼───┼────┼────┼───┤
                                             │-f        │ R │ RD │ RD │ R │
                                             ├──────────┼───┼────┼────┼───┤
                                             │-A        │ W │ W  │ W  │ R │
                                             ├──────────┼───┼────┼────┼───┤
                                             │-Af       │ R │ R  │ R  │ R │
                                             └──────────┴───┴────┴────┴───┘

       Note   hg  remove never  deletes files in Added [A] state from the working directory, not even if --force
              is specified.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if any warnings encountered.

       Options:

       -A, --after
              record delete for missing files

       -f, --force
              forget added files, delete modified files

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: rm

   rename
       rename files; equivalent of copy + remove:

       hg rename [OPTION]... SOURCE... DEST

       Mark dest as copies of sources; mark sources for deletion. If dest is a directory, copies are put in that
       directory. If dest is a file, there can only be one source.

       By  default, this command copies the contents of files as they exist in the working directory. If invoked
       with -A/--after, the operation is recorded, but no copying is performed.

       This command takes effect at the next commit. To undo a rename before that, see hg revert.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if errors are encountered.

       Options:

       -A, --after
              record a rename that has already occurred

       -f, --force
              forcibly move over an existing managed file

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: move mv

   resolve
       redo merges or set/view the merge status of files:

       hg resolve [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Merges with unresolved conflicts are often the result of non-interactive merging using the internal:merge
       configuration setting, or a command-line merge tool like diff3. The resolve command is used to manage the
       files involved in a merge, after hg merge has been run, and before hg commit is  run  (i.e.  the  working
       directory must have two parents). See hg help merge-tools for information on configuring merge tools.

       The resolve command can be used in the following ways:

       • hg  resolve [--re-merge] [--tool TOOL] FILE...: attempt to re-merge the specified files, discarding any
         previous merge attempts. Re-merging is not performed for files already marked as resolved. Use --all/-a
         to  select all unresolved files. --tool can be used to specify the merge tool used for the given files.
         It overrides the HGMERGE environment variable and your configuration files.  Previous file contents are
         saved with a .orig suffix.

       • hg  resolve  -m  [FILE]:  mark  a file as having been resolved (e.g. after having manually fixed-up the
         files). The default is to mark all unresolved files.

       • hg resolve -u [FILE]...: mark a file as unresolved. The default is to mark all resolved files.

       • hg resolve -l: list files which had or still have conflicts.  In the printed list, U = unresolved and R
         =  resolved.   You  can use set:unresolved() or set:resolved() to filter the list. See hg help filesets
         for details.

       Note   Mercurial will not let you commit files with unresolved merge conflicts. You must use  hg  resolve
              -m ... before you can commit after a conflicting merge.

       Template:

       The  following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See also
       hg help templates.

       mergestatus
              String. Character denoting merge conflicts, U or R.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if any files fail a resolve attempt.

       Options:

       -a, --all
              select all unresolved files

       -l, --list
              list state of files needing merge

       -m, --mark
              mark files as resolved

       -u, --unmark
              mark files as unresolved

       -n, --no-status
              hide status prefix

       --re-merge
              re-merge files

       -t,--tool <TOOL>
              specify merge tool

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   revert
       restore files to their checkout state:

       hg revert [OPTION]... [-r REV] [NAME]...

       Note   To check out earlier revisions, you should use hg update REV.  To cancel an uncommitted merge (and
              lose your changes), use hg merge --abort.

       With  no  revision  specified,  revert the specified files or directories to the contents they had in the
       parent of the working directory.  This restores  the  contents  of  files  to  an  unmodified  state  and
       unschedules  adds,  removes,  copies,  and  renames.  If  the working directory has two parents, you must
       explicitly specify a revision.

       Using the -r/--rev or -d/--date options, revert the given files or directories to their states  as  of  a
       specific  revision.  Because  revert does not change the working directory parents, this will cause these
       files to appear modified. This can be helpful to "back out" some or all of  an  earlier  change.  See  hg
       backout for a related method.

       Modified  files  are  saved  with  a  .orig  suffix  before  reverting.   To  disable  these backups, use
       --no-backup. It is possible to store the backup files in a custom directory relative to the root  of  the
       repository by setting the ui.origbackuppath configuration option.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       See hg help backout for a way to reverse the effect of an earlier changeset.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -a, --all
              revert all changes when no arguments given

       -d,--date <DATE>
              tipmost revision matching date

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revert to the specified revision

       -C, --no-backup
              do not save backup copies of files

       -i, --interactive
              interactively select the changes

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   root
       print the root (top) of the current working directory:

       hg root

       Print the root directory of the current repository.

       Template:

       The  following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See also
       hg help templates.

       hgpath String. Path to the .hg directory.

       storepath
              String. Path to the directory holding versioned data.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   shelve
       save and set aside changes from the working directory:

       hg shelve [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Shelving takes files that "hg status" reports as not clean,  saves  the  modifications  to  a  bundle  (a
       shelved change), and reverts the files so that their state in the working directory becomes clean.

       To restore these changes to the working directory, using "hg unshelve"; this will work even if you switch
       to a different commit.

       When no files are specified, "hg shelve" saves all not-clean files. If specific files or directories  are
       named, only changes to those files are shelved.

       In  bare  shelve (when no files are specified, without interactive, include and exclude option), shelving
       remembers information if the working directory was on  newly  created  branch,  in  other  words  working
       directory  was  on  different  branch than its first parent. In this situation unshelving restores branch
       information to the working directory.

       Each shelved change has a name that makes it easier to find later.  The name of a shelved change defaults
       to  being  based on the active bookmark, or if there is no active bookmark, the current named branch.  To
       specify a different name, use --name.

       To see a list of existing shelved changes, use the --list option. For  each  shelved  change,  this  will
       print its name, age, and description; use --patch or --stat for more details.

       To delete specific shelved changes, use --delete. To delete all shelved changes, use --cleanup.

       Options:

       -A, --addremove
              mark new/missing files as added/removed before shelving

       -u, --unknown
              store unknown files in the shelve

       --cleanup
              delete all shelved changes

       --date <DATE>
              shelve with the specified commit date

       -d, --delete
              delete the named shelved change(s)

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -k, --keep
              shelve, but keep changes in the working directory

       -l, --list
              list current shelves

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as shelve message

       -n,--name <NAME>
              use the given name for the shelved commit

       -p, --patch
              output patches for changes (provide the names of the shelved changes as positional arguments)

       -i, --interactive
              interactive mode

       --stat output  diffstat-style  summary of changes (provide the names of the shelved changes as positional
              arguments)

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   status
       show changed files in the working directory:

       hg status [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Show status of files in the repository. If names are given, only files that match are shown.  Files  that
       are  clean  or  ignored  or  the  source  of  a  copy/move  operation,  are not listed unless -c/--clean,
       -i/--ignored, -C/--copies or -A/--all are given.  Unless options  described  with  "show  only  ..."  are
       given, the options -mardu are used.

       Option  -q/--quiet  hides  untracked  (unknown  and  ignored)  files  unless  explicitly  requested  with
       -u/--unknown or -i/--ignored.

       Note   hg status may appear to disagree with diff if permissions have changed or a  merge  has  occurred.
              The standard diff format does not report permission changes and diff only reports changes relative
              to one merge parent.

       If one revision is given, it is used as the base revision.  If two revisions are given,  the  differences
       between them are shown. The --change option can also be used as a shortcut to list the changed files of a
       revision from its first parent.

       The codes used to show the status of files are:

       M = modified
       A = added
       R = removed
       C = clean
       ! = missing (deleted by non-hg command, but still tracked)
       ? = not tracked
       I = ignored
         = origin of the previous file (with --copies)

       The -t/--terse option abbreviates the output by showing only the directory name if all the  files  in  it
       share  the  same  status.  The  option  takes  an argument indicating the statuses to abbreviate: 'm' for
       'modified', 'a' for 'added', 'r' for 'removed', 'd' for 'deleted', 'u' for 'unknown', 'i'  for  'ignored'
       and 'c' for clean.

       It  abbreviates only those statuses which are passed. Note that clean and ignored files are not displayed
       with '--terse ic' unless the -c/--clean and -i/--ignored options are also used.

       The -v/--verbose option shows information when the repository is in an unfinished merge,  shelve,  rebase
       state  etc.  You  can  have  this  behavior  turned on by default by enabling the commands.status.verbose
       option.

       You can skip displaying some of these states by setting commands.status.skipstates to  one  or  more  of:
       'bisect', 'graft', 'histedit', 'merge', 'rebase', or 'unshelve'.

       Template:

       The  following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See also
       hg help templates.

       path   String. Repository-absolute path of the file.

       source String. Repository-absolute path of the file originated from.  Available if --copies is specified.

       status String. Character denoting file's status.

       Examples:

       • show changes in the working directory relative to a changeset:

         hg status --rev 9353

       • show changes in the working directory relative to the current directory (see hg help patterns for  more
         information):

         hg status re:

       • show all changes including copies in an existing changeset:

         hg status --copies --change 9353

       • get a NUL separated list of added files, suitable for xargs:

         hg status -an0

       • show  more information about the repository status, abbreviating added, removed, modified, deleted, and
         untracked paths:

         hg status -v -t mardu

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -A, --all
              show status of all files

       -m, --modified
              show only modified files

       -a, --added
              show only added files

       -r, --removed
              show only removed files

       -d, --deleted
              show only deleted (but tracked) files

       -c, --clean
              show only files without changes

       -u, --unknown
              show only unknown (not tracked) files

       -i, --ignored
              show only ignored files

       -n, --no-status
              hide status prefix

       -t,--terse <VALUE>
              show the terse output (EXPERIMENTAL) (default: nothing)

       -C, --copies
              show source of copied files

       -0, --print0
              end filenames with NUL, for use with xargs

       --rev <REV[+]>
              show difference from revision

       --change <REV>
              list the changed files of a revision

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: st

   summary
       summarize working directory state:

       hg summary [--remote]

       This generates a brief summary of the working directory state, including parents, branch, commit  status,
       phase and available updates.

       With  the  --remote option, this will check the default paths for incoming and outgoing changes. This can
       be time-consuming.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       --remote
              check for push and pull

              aliases: sum

   unshelve
       restore a shelved change to the working directory:

       hg unshelve [OPTION]... [[-n] SHELVED]

       This command accepts an optional name of a shelved change to restore. If none is given, the  most  recent
       shelved change is used.

       If  a  shelved change is applied successfully, the bundle that contains the shelved changes is moved to a
       backup location (.hg/shelve-backup).

       Since you can restore a shelved change on top of an arbitrary commit, it is possible that unshelving will
       result  in  a  conflict between your changes and the commits you are unshelving onto. If this occurs, you
       must resolve the conflict, then use --continue to complete the unshelve operation. (The bundle  will  not
       be moved until you successfully complete the unshelve.)

       (Alternatively,  you  can  use  --abort  to  abandon an unshelve that causes a conflict. This reverts the
       unshelved changes, and leaves the bundle in place.)

       If bare shelved change (without interactive, include and exclude option) was done on newly created branch
       it would restore branch information to the working directory.

       After a successful unshelve, the shelved changes are stored in a backup directory. Only the N most recent
       backups are kept. N defaults to 10 but  can  be  overridden  using  the  shelve.maxbackups  configuration
       option.

       Timestamp  in  seconds is used to decide order of backups. More than maxbackups backups are kept, if same
       timestamp prevents from deciding exact order of them, for safety.

       Selected changes can be unshelved with --interactive flag.  The working directory  is  updated  with  the
       selected  changes,  and only the unselected changes remain shelved.  Note: The whole shelve is applied to
       working directory first before running interactively. So, this will bring up all  the  conflicts  between
       working directory and the shelve, irrespective of which changes will be unshelved.

       Options:

       -a, --abort
              abort an incomplete unshelve operation

       -c, --continue
              continue an incomplete unshelve operation

       -i, --interactive
              use interactive mode (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -k, --keep
              keep shelve after unshelving

       -n,--name <NAME>
              restore shelved change with given name

       -t,--tool <VALUE>
              specify merge tool

       --date <DATE>
              set date for temporary commits (DEPRECATED)

   update
       update working directory (or switch revisions):

       hg update [-C|-c|-m] [-d DATE] [[-r] REV]

       Update  the  repository's  working  directory  to  the specified changeset. If no changeset is specified,
       update to the tip of the current named branch and move the active bookmark (see hg help bookmarks).

       Update sets the working directory's parent revision to the specified changeset (see hg help parents).

       If the changeset is not a descendant or  ancestor  of  the  working  directory's  parent  and  there  are
       uncommitted  changes, the update is aborted. With the -c/--check option, the working directory is checked
       for uncommitted changes; if none are found, the working directory is updated to the specified changeset.

       The -C/--clean, -c/--check, and -m/--merge options control what happens if the working directory contains
       uncommitted changes.  At most of one of them can be specified.

       1. If  no option is specified, and if the requested changeset is an ancestor or descendant of the working
          directory's parent, the uncommitted changes are merged into the requested  changeset  and  the  merged
          result  is  left uncommitted. If the requested changeset is not an ancestor or descendant (that is, it
          is on another branch), the update is aborted and the uncommitted changes are preserved.

       2. With the -m/--merge option, the update is allowed even if the requested changeset is not  an  ancestor
          or descendant of the working directory's parent.

       3. With the -c/--check option, the update is aborted and the uncommitted changes are preserved.

       4. With  the -C/--clean option, uncommitted changes are discarded and the working directory is updated to
          the requested changeset.

       To cancel an uncommitted merge (and lose your changes), use hg merge --abort.

       Use null as the changeset to remove the working directory (like hg clone -U).

       If you want to revert just one file to an older revision, use hg revert [-r REV] NAME.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if there are unresolved files.

       Options:

       -C, --clean
              discard uncommitted changes (no backup)

       -c, --check
              require clean working directory

       -m, --merge
              merge uncommitted changes

       -d,--date <DATE>
              tipmost revision matching date

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision

       -t,--tool <TOOL>
              specify merge tool

              aliases: up checkout co

   Change import/export
   archive
       create an unversioned archive of a repository revision:

       hg archive [OPTION]... DEST

       By default, the revision used is the parent of the working directory; use -r/--rev to specify a different
       revision.

       The archive type is automatically detected based on file extension (to override, use -t/--type).

       Examples:

       • create a zip file containing the 1.0 release:

         hg archive -r 1.0 project-1.0.zip

       • create a tarball excluding .hg files:

         hg archive project.tar.gz -X ".hg*"

       Valid types are:

       files

              a directory full of files (default)

       tar

              tar archive, uncompressed

       tbz2

              tar archive, compressed using bzip2

       tgz

              tar archive, compressed using gzip

       txz

              tar archive, compressed using lzma (only in Python 3)

       uzip

              zip archive, uncompressed

       zip

              zip archive, compressed using deflate

       The exact name of the destination archive or directory is given using a format string; see hg help export
       for details.

       Each member added to an archive file has a directory prefix  prepended.  Use  -p/--prefix  to  specify  a
       format string for the prefix. The default is the basename of the archive, with suffixes removed.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       --no-decode
              do not pass files through decoders

       -p,--prefix <PREFIX>
              directory prefix for files in archive

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to distribute

       -t,--type <TYPE>
              type of distribution to create

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   bundle
       create a bundle file:

       hg bundle [-f] [-t BUNDLESPEC] [-a] [-r REV]... [--base REV]... FILE [DEST]

       Generate a bundle file containing data to be transferred to another repository.

       To  create  a  bundle containing all changesets, use -a/--all (or --base null). Otherwise, hg assumes the
       destination will have all the nodes you specify with --base parameters. Otherwise,  hg  will  assume  the
       repository  has  all  the  nodes  in destination, or default-push/default if no destination is specified,
       where destination is the repository you provide through DEST option.

       You can change bundle format with the -t/--type option. See hg help bundlespec for documentation on  this
       format. By default, the most appropriate format is used and compression defaults to bzip2.

       The  bundle  file can then be transferred using conventional means and applied to another repository with
       the unbundle or pull command. This is useful when  direct  push  and  pull  are  not  available  or  when
       exporting an entire repository is undesirable.

       Applying  bundles  preserves  all  changeset contents including permissions, copy/rename information, and
       revision history.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if no changes found.

       Options:

       -f, --force
              run even when the destination is unrelated

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a changeset intended to be added to the destination

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              a specific branch you would like to bundle

       --base <REV[+]>
              a base changeset assumed to be available at the destination

       -a, --all
              bundle all changesets in the repository

       -t,--type <TYPE>
              bundle compression type to use (default: bzip2)

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   export
       dump the header and diffs for one or more changesets:

       hg export [OPTION]... [-o OUTFILESPEC] [-r] [REV]...

       Print the changeset header and diffs for one or more revisions.  If no revision is given, the  parent  of
       the working directory is used.

       The  information  shown in the changeset header is: author, date, branch name (if non-default), changeset
       hash, parent(s) and commit comment.

       Note   hg export may generate unexpected diff output for merge changesets, as it will compare  the  merge
              changeset against its first parent only.

       Output may be to a file, in which case the name of the file is given using a template string. See hg help
       templates. In addition to the common template keywords, the following formatting rules are supported:

       %%

              literal "%" character

       %H

              changeset hash (40 hexadecimal digits)

       %N

              number of patches being generated

       %R

              changeset revision number

       %b

              basename of the exporting repository

       %h

              short-form changeset hash (12 hexadecimal digits)

       %m

              first line of the commit message (only alphanumeric characters)

       %n

              zero-padded sequence number, starting at 1

       %r

              zero-padded changeset revision number

       \

              literal "" character

       Without the -a/--text option, export will avoid generating diffs of files it detects as binary. With  -a,
       export will generate a diff anyway, probably with undesirable results.

       With -B/--bookmark changesets reachable by the given bookmark are selected.

       Use  the  -g/--git  option  to generate diffs in the git extended diff format. See hg help diffs for more
       information.

       With the --switch-parent option, the diff will be against the second parent. It can be useful to review a
       merge.

       Template:

       The  following keywords are supported in addition to the common template keywords and functions. See also
       hg help templates.

       diff   String. Diff content.

       parents
              List of strings. Parent nodes of the changeset.

       Examples:

       • use export and import to transplant a bugfix to the current branch:

         hg export -r 9353 | hg import -

       • export all the changesets between two revisions to a file with rename information:

         hg export --git -r 123:150 > changes.txt

       • split outgoing changes into a series of patches with descriptive names:

         hg export -r "outgoing()" -o "%n-%m.patch"

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -B,--bookmark <BOOKMARK>
              export changes only reachable by given bookmark

       -o,--output <FORMAT>
              print output to file with formatted name

       --switch-parent
              diff against the second parent

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revisions to export

       -a, --text
              treat all files as text

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       --binary
              generate binary diffs in git mode (default)

       --nodates
              omit dates from diff headers

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   import
       import an ordered set of patches:

       hg import [OPTION]... PATCH...

       Import a list of patches and commit them individually (unless --no-commit is specified).

       To read a patch from standard input (stdin), use "-" as the patch name. If a URL is specified, the  patch
       will be downloaded from there.

       Import  first  applies changes to the working directory (unless --bypass is specified), import will abort
       if there are outstanding changes.

       Use --bypass to apply and commit patches directly  to  the  repository,  without  affecting  the  working
       directory. Without --exact, patches will be applied on top of the working directory parent revision.

       You  can  import  a patch straight from a mail message. Even patches as attachments work (to use the body
       part, it must have type text/plain or text/x-patch). From and Subject headers of email message  are  used
       as  default  committer  and  commit message. All text/plain body parts before first diff are added to the
       commit message.

       If the imported patch was generated by hg export, user and description from patch  override  values  from
       message headers and body. Values given on command line with -m/--message and -u/--user override these.

       If  --exact  is  specified,  import  will  set  the  working directory to the parent of each patch before
       applying it, and will abort if the resulting changeset has a different ID than the one  recorded  in  the
       patch.  This  will  guard against various ways that portable patch formats and mail systems might fail to
       transfer Mercurial data or metadata. See hg bundle for lossless transmission.

       Use --partial to ensure a changeset will be created from the patch even if  some  hunks  fail  to  apply.
       Hunks  that  fail to apply will be written to a <target-file>.rej file. Conflicts can then be resolved by
       hand before hg commit --amend is run to update the created changeset. This  flag  exists  to  let  people
       import  patches  that  partially apply without losing the associated metadata (author, date, description,
       ...).

       Note   When no hunks apply cleanly, hg import --partial will create an empty  changeset,  importing  only
              the patch metadata.

       With  -s/--similarity,  hg will attempt to discover renames and copies in the patch in the same way as hg
       addremove.

       It is possible to use external patch programs to perform the patch by setting the ui.patch  configuration
       option.  For  the  default  internal  tool,  the fuzz can also be configured via patch.fuzz.  See hg help
       config for more information about configuration files and how to use these options.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Examples:

       • import a traditional patch from a website and detect renames:

         hg import -s 80 http://example.com/bugfix.patch

       • import a changeset from an hgweb server:

         hg import https://www.mercurial-scm.org/repo/hg/rev/5ca8c111e9aa

       • import all the patches in an Unix-style mbox:

         hg import incoming-patches.mbox

       • import patches from stdin:

         hg import -

       • attempt to exactly restore an exported changeset (not always possible):

         hg import --exact proposed-fix.patch

       • use an external tool to apply a patch which is too fuzzy for the default internal tool.

            hg import --config ui.patch="patch --merge" fuzzy.patch

       • change the default fuzzing from 2 to a less strict 7

            hg import --config ui.fuzz=7 fuzz.patch

       Returns 0 on success, 1 on partial success (see --partial).

       Options:

       -p,--strip <NUM>
              directory strip option for patch. This has the same meaning  as  the  corresponding  patch  option
              (default: 1)

       -b,--base <PATH>
              base path (DEPRECATED)

       --secret
              use the secret phase for committing

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -f, --force
              skip check for outstanding uncommitted changes (DEPRECATED)

       --no-commit
              don't commit, just update the working directory

       --bypass
              apply patch without touching the working directory

       --partial
              commit even if some hunks fail

       --exact
              abort if patch would apply lossily

       --prefix <DIR>
              apply patch to subdirectory

       --import-branch
              use any branch information in patch (implied by --exact)

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -s,--similarity <SIMILARITY>
              guess renamed files by similarity (0<=s<=100)

              aliases: patch

   unbundle
       apply one or more bundle files:

       hg unbundle [-u] FILE...

       Apply one or more bundle files generated by hg bundle.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if an update has unresolved files.

       Options:

       -u, --update
              update to new branch head if changesets were unbundled

   Repository maintenance
   manifest
       output the current or given revision of the project manifest:

       hg manifest [-r REV]

       Print  a  list  of  version  controlled files for the given revision.  If no revision is given, the first
       parent of the working directory is used, or the null revision if no revision is checked out.

       With -v, print file permissions, symlink and executable bits.  With --debug, print file revision hashes.

       If option --all is specified, the list of all files from all revisions is printed. This includes  deleted
       and renamed files.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to display

       --all  list files from all revisions

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   recover
       roll back an interrupted transaction:

       hg recover

       Recover from an interrupted commit or pull.

       This  command  tries  to  fix  the  repository  status  after an interrupted operation. It should only be
       necessary when Mercurial suggests it.

       Returns 0 if successful, 1 if nothing to recover or verify fails.

       Options:

       --verify
              run hg verify after successful recover (default: True)

   rollback
       roll back the last transaction (DANGEROUS) (DEPRECATED):

       hg rollback

       Please use hg commit --amend instead of rollback to correct mistakes in the last commit.

       This command should be used with care. There is only one level of rollback, and there is no way to undo a
       rollback.  It  will  also  restore  the dirstate at the time of the last transaction, losing any dirstate
       changes since that time. This command does not alter the working directory.

       Transactions are used to encapsulate the effects of all commands that create new changesets or  propagate
       existing changesets into a repository.

       For example, the following commands are transactional, and their effects can be rolled back:

       • commit

       • import

       • pull

       • push (with this repository as the destination)

       • unbundle

       To  avoid  permanent data loss, rollback will refuse to rollback a commit transaction if it isn't checked
       out. Use --force to override this protection.

       The rollback command can be entirely disabled by setting the ui.rollback configuration setting to  false.
       If  you're  here  because  you  want  to use rollback and it's disabled, you can re-enable the command by
       setting ui.rollback to true.

       This command is not intended for use on public repositories. Once changes are visible for pull  by  other
       users,  rolling  a  transaction  back  locally  is  ineffective (someone else may already have pulled the
       changes). Furthermore, a race is possible with readers of the repository; for example an in-progress pull
       from the repository may fail if a rollback is performed.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if no rollback data is available.

       Options:

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       -f, --force
              ignore safety measures

   verify
       verify the integrity of the repository:

       hg verify

       Verify the integrity of the current repository.

       This  will  perform an extensive check of the repository's integrity, validating the hashes and checksums
       of each entry in the changelog, manifest, and tracked files, as well as the integrity of their crosslinks
       and indices.

       Please  see  https://mercurial-scm.org/wiki/RepositoryCorruption for more information about recovery from
       corruption of the repository.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if errors are encountered.

       Options:

       --full perform more checks (EXPERIMENTAL)

   Help
   config
       show combined config settings from all hgrc files:

       hg config [-u] [NAME]...

       With no arguments, print names and values of all config items.

       With one argument of the form section.name, print just the value of that config item.

       With multiple arguments, print names and values of all  config  items  with  matching  section  names  or
       section.names.

       With  --edit,  start  an editor on the user-level config file. With --global, edit the system-wide config
       file. With --local, edit the repository-level config file.

       With --debug, the source (filename and line number) is printed for each config item.

       See hg help config for more information about config files.

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported. See also hg help templates.

       name   String. Config name.

       source String. Filename and line number where the item is defined.

       value  String. Config value.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if NAME does not exist.

       Options:

       -u, --untrusted
              show untrusted configuration options

       -e, --edit
              edit user config

       -l, --local
              edit repository config

       -g, --global
              edit global config

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

              aliases: showconfig debugconfig

   help
       show help for a given topic or a help overview:

       hg help [-eck] [-s PLATFORM] [TOPIC]

       With no arguments, print a list of commands with short help messages.

       Given a topic, extension, or command name, print help for that topic.

       Returns 0 if successful.

       Options:

       -e, --extension
              show only help for extensions

       -c, --command
              show only help for commands

       -k, --keyword
              show topics matching keyword

       -s,--system <PLATFORM[+]>
              show help for specific platform(s)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   version
       output version and copyright information:

       hg version

       Template:

       The following keywords are supported. See also hg help templates.

       extensions
              List of extensions.

       ver    String. Version number.

       And each entry of {extensions} provides the following sub-keywords in addition to {ver}.

       bundled
              Boolean. True if included in the release.

       name   String. Extension name.

       Options:

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   Uncategorized commands

BUNDLE FILE FORMATS

       Mercurial supports generating standalone "bundle" files that hold repository data.  These  "bundles"  are
       typically saved locally and used later or exchanged between different repositories, possibly on different
       machines. Example commands using bundles are hg bundle and hg unbundle.

       Generation of bundle files is controlled by a "bundle specification" ("bundlespec") string.  This  string
       tells the bundle generation process how to create the bundle.

       A "bundlespec" string is composed of the following elements:

       type   A string denoting the bundle format to use.

       compression
              Denotes the compression engine to use compressing the raw bundle data.

       parameters
              Arbitrary key-value parameters to further control bundle generation.

       A "bundlespec" string has the following formats:

       <type> The literal bundle format string is used.

       <compression>-<type>
              The compression engine and format are delimited by a hyphen (-).

       Optional parameters follow the <type>. Parameters are URI escaped key=value pairs. Each pair is delimited
       by a semicolon (;). The first parameter begins after a ; immediately following the <type> value.

   Available Types
       The following bundle <type> strings are available:

       v1     Produces a legacy "changegroup" version 1 bundle.

              This format is compatible with nearly all Mercurial clients because it is the oldest. However,  it
              has some limitations, which is why it is no longer the default for new repositories.

              v1  bundles can be used with modern repositories using the "generaldelta" storage format. However,
              it may take longer to produce the bundle and the resulting bundle may be significantly larger than
              a v2 bundle.

              v1 bundles can only use the gzip, bzip2, and none compression formats.

       v2     Produces a version 2 bundle.

              Version  2  bundles  are  an  extensible format that can store additional repository data (such as
              bookmarks and phases information) and they can store data more efficiently, resulting  in  smaller
              bundles.

              Version  2  bundles  can  also use modern compression engines, such as zstd, making them faster to
              compress and often smaller.

   Available Compression Engines
       The following bundle <compression> engines can be used:

       bzip2

              An algorithm that produces smaller bundles than gzip.

              All Mercurial clients should support this format.

              This engine will likely produce smaller bundles than gzip but will be significantly  slower,  both
              during compression and decompression.

              If available, the zstd engine can yield similar or better compression at much higher speeds.

       gzip

              zlib compression using the DEFLATE algorithm.

              All  Mercurial  clients should support this format. The compression algorithm strikes a reasonable
              balance between compression ratio and size.

       none

              No compression is performed.

              Use this compression engine to explicitly disable compression.

   Examples
       v2

              Produce a v2 bundle using default options, including compression.

       none-v1

              Produce a v1 bundle with no compression.

       zstd-v2

              Produce a v2 bundle with zstandard compression using default settings.

       zstd-v1

              This errors because zstd is not supported for v1 types.

COLORIZING OUTPUTS

       Mercurial colorizes output from several commands.

       For example, the diff command shows additions in green and deletions in red,  while  the  status  command
       shows  modified  files in magenta. Many other commands have analogous colors. It is possible to customize
       these colors.

       To enable color (default) whenever possible use:

       [ui]
       color = yes

       To disable color use:

       [ui]
       color = no

       See hg help config.ui.color for details.

       The default pager on Windows does not support color, so  enabling  the  pager  will  effectively  disable
       color.  See hg help config.ui.paginate to disable the pager.  Alternately, MSYS and Cygwin shells provide
       less as a pager, which can be configured to support ANSI color mode.  Windows 10 natively  supports  ANSI
       color mode.

   Mode
       Mercurial  can  use  various systems to display color. The supported modes are ansi, win32, and terminfo.
       See hg help config.color for details about how to control the mode.

   Effects
       Other effects in addition to color, like bold and underlined text, are also available.  By  default,  the
       terminfo database is used to find the terminal codes used to change color and effect.  If terminfo is not
       available, then effects are rendered with the ECMA-48 SGR control function (aka ANSI escape codes).

       The available effects in terminfo mode are 'blink',  'bold',  'dim',  'inverse',  'invisible',  'italic',
       'standout',  and  'underline';  in  ECMA-48  mode,  the  options  are  'bold',  'inverse',  'italic', and
       'underline'.  How each is rendered depends on the terminal emulator.  Some may not  be  available  for  a
       given terminal type, and will be silently ignored.

       If  the  terminfo  entry for your terminal is missing codes for an effect or has the wrong codes, you can
       add or override those codes in your configuration:

       [color]
       terminfo.dim = \E[2m

       where 'E' is substituted with an escape character.

   Labels
       Text receives color effects depending on the labels that it has. Many  default  Mercurial  commands  emit
       labelled  text.  You  can  also define your own labels in templates using the label function, see hg help
       templates. A single portion of text may have more than one label. In that case, effects given to the last
       label  will  override  any  other effects. This includes the special "none" effect, which nullifies other
       effects.

       Labels are normally invisible. In order to see these labels and their  position  in  the  text,  use  the
       global --color=debug option. The same anchor text may be associated to multiple labels, e.g.

          [log.changeset changeset.secret|changeset:   22611:6f0a53c8f587]

       The  following  are  the  default effects for some default labels. Default effects may be overridden from
       your configuration file:

       [color]
       status.modified = blue bold underline red_background
       status.added = green bold
       status.removed = red bold blue_background
       status.deleted = cyan bold underline
       status.unknown = magenta bold underline
       status.ignored = black bold

       # 'none' turns off all effects
       status.clean = none
       status.copied = none

       qseries.applied = blue bold underline
       qseries.unapplied = black bold
       qseries.missing = red bold

       diff.diffline = bold
       diff.extended = cyan bold
       diff.file_a = red bold
       diff.file_b = green bold
       diff.hunk = magenta
       diff.deleted = red
       diff.inserted = green
       diff.changed = white
       diff.tab =
       diff.trailingwhitespace = bold red_background

       # Blank so it inherits the style of the surrounding label
       changeset.public =
       changeset.draft =
       changeset.secret =

       resolve.unresolved = red bold
       resolve.resolved = green bold

       bookmarks.active = green

       branches.active = none
       branches.closed = black bold
       branches.current = green
       branches.inactive = none

       tags.normal = green
       tags.local = black bold

       rebase.rebased = blue
       rebase.remaining = red bold

       shelve.age = cyan
       shelve.newest = green bold
       shelve.name = blue bold

       histedit.remaining = red bold

   Custom colors
       Because there are only eight standard colors, Mercurial allows you to define color names for other  color
       slots which might be available for your terminal type, assuming terminfo mode.  For instance:

       color.brightblue = 12
       color.pink = 207
       color.orange = 202

       to  set 'brightblue' to color slot 12 (useful for 16 color terminals that have brighter colors defined in
       the upper eight) and, 'pink' and 'orange' to colors in  256-color  xterm's  default  color  cube.   These
       defined colors may then be used as any of the pre-defined eight, including appending '_background' to set
       the background to that color.

DATE FORMATS

       Some commands allow the user to specify a date, e.g.:

       • backout, commit, import, tag: Specify the commit date.

       • log, revert, update: Select revision(s) by date.

       Many date formats are valid. Here are some examples:

       • Wed Dec 6 13:18:29 2006 (local timezone assumed)

       • Dec 6 13:18 -0600 (year assumed, time offset provided)

       • Dec 6 13:18 UTC (UTC and GMT are aliases for +0000)

       • Dec 6 (midnight)

       • 13:18 (today assumed)

       • 3:39 (3:39AM assumed)

       • 3:39pm (15:39)

       • 2006-12-06 13:18:29 (ISO 8601 format)

       • 2006-12-6 13:182006-12-612-612/612/6/6 (Dec 6 2006)

       • today (midnight)

       • yesterday (midnight)

       • now - right now

       Lastly, there is Mercurial's internal format:

       • 1165411109 0 (Wed Dec 6 13:18:29 2006 UTC)

       This is the internal representation format for dates. The first number is the number of seconds since the
       epoch  (1970-01-01  00:00  UTC).  The  second is the offset of the local timezone, in seconds west of UTC
       (negative if the timezone is east of UTC).

       The log command also accepts date ranges:

       • <DATE - at or before a given date/time

       • >DATE - on or after a given date/time

       • DATE to DATE - a date range, inclusive

       • -DAYS - within a given number of days of today

DEPRECATED FEATURES

       Mercurial evolves over time, some features, options, commands may be replaced by better and  more  secure
       alternatives.  This  topic  will  help  you  migrating  your existing usage and/or configuration to newer
       features.

   Commands
       The following commands are still available but their use are not recommended:

       locate

       This command has been replaced by hg files.

       parents

       This command can be replaced by hg summary or hg log with appropriate revsets. See hg  help  revsets  for
       more information.

       tip

       The recommended alternative is hg heads.

   Options
       web.allowpull

              Renamed to allow-pull.

       web.allow_push

              Renamed to allow-push.

DIFF FORMATS

       Mercurial's  default  format  for  showing  changes between two versions of a file is compatible with the
       unified format of GNU diff, which can be used by GNU patch and many other standard tools.

       While this standard format is often enough, it does not encode the following information:

       • executable status and other permission bits

       • copy or rename information

       • changes in binary files

       • creation or deletion of empty files

       Mercurial also supports the extended diff format from the git VCS which addresses these limitations.  The
       git  diff  format  is not produced by default because a few widespread tools still do not understand this
       format.

       This means that when generating diffs from a Mercurial repository (e.g. with hg export),  you  should  be
       careful  about things like file copies and renames or other things mentioned above, because when applying
       a standard diff to  a  different  repository,  this  extra  information  is  lost.  Mercurial's  internal
       operations  (like push and pull) are not affected by this, because they use an internal binary format for
       communicating changes.

       To make Mercurial produce the git extended diff format, use the --git option available for many commands,
       or  set 'git = True' in the [diff] section of your configuration file. You do not need to set this option
       when importing diffs in this format or using them in the mq extension.

ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES

       HG     Path to the 'hg' executable, automatically passed  when  running  hooks,  extensions  or  external
              tools.  If unset or empty, this is the hg executable's name if it's frozen, or an executable named
              'hg' (with %PATHEXT% [defaulting to COM/EXE/BAT/CMD] extensions on Windows) is searched.

       HGEDITOR
              This is the name of the editor to run when committing. See EDITOR.

              (deprecated, see hg help config.ui.editor)

       HGENCODING
              This overrides the default locale setting detected by Mercurial.  This setting is used to  convert
              data  including  usernames,  changeset  descriptions, tag names, and branches. This setting can be
              overridden with the --encoding command-line option.

       HGENCODINGMODE
              This sets Mercurial's behavior for handling unknown characters while transcoding user  input.  The
              default  is  "strict", which causes Mercurial to abort if it can't map a character. Other settings
              include "replace", which replaces unknown characters, and "ignore", which drops them. This setting
              can be overridden with the --encodingmode command-line option.

       HGENCODINGAMBIGUOUS
              This sets Mercurial's behavior for handling characters with "ambiguous" widths like accented Latin
              characters with East Asian fonts. By default, Mercurial assumes ambiguous characters  are  narrow,
              set this variable to "wide" if such characters cause formatting problems.

       HGMERGE
              An  executable  to  use  for  resolving  merge  conflicts. The program will be executed with three
              arguments: local file, remote file, ancestor file.

              (deprecated, see hg help config.ui.merge)

       HGRCPATH
              A list of files or directories to search for configuration files. Item separator is ":"  on  Unix,
              ";"  on  Windows. If HGRCPATH is not set, platform default search path is used. If empty, only the
              .hg/hgrc from the current repository is read.

              For each element in HGRCPATH:

              • if it's a directory, all files ending with .rc are added

              • otherwise, the file itself will be added

       HGRCSKIPREPO
              When set, the .hg/hgrc from repositories are not read.

       HGPLAIN
              When set, this disables any configuration settings that might change Mercurial's  default  output.
              This  includes  encoding,  defaults,  verbose  mode,  debug  mode,  quiet  mode,  tracebacks,  and
              localization. This can be useful when scripting against Mercurial in the  face  of  existing  user
              configuration.

              In  addition to the features disabled by HGPLAIN=, the following values can be specified to adjust
              behavior:

              +strictflags

                     Restrict parsing of command line flags.

              Equivalent options set via command line flags or environment variables are not overridden.

              See hg help scripting for details.

       HGPLAINEXCEPT
              This is a comma-separated list of features to preserve when  HGPLAIN  is  enabled.  Currently  the
              following values are supported:

              alias

                     Don't remove aliases.

              color

                     Don't disable colored output.

              i18n

                     Preserve internationalization.

              revsetalias

                     Don't remove revset aliases.

              templatealias

                     Don't remove template aliases.

              progress

                     Don't hide progress output.

              Setting HGPLAINEXCEPT to anything (even an empty string) will enable plain mode.

       HGUSER This is the string used as the author of a commit. If not set, available values will be considered
              in this order:

              • HGUSER (deprecated)

              • configuration files from the HGRCPATH

              • EMAIL

              • interactive prompt

              • LOGNAME (with @hostname appended)

              (deprecated, see hg help config.ui.username)

       EMAIL  May be used as the author of a commit; see HGUSER.

       LOGNAME
              May be used as the author of a commit; see HGUSER.

       VISUAL This is the name of the editor to use when committing. See EDITOR.

       EDITOR Sometimes Mercurial needs to open a text file in an editor for a user to modify, for example  when
              writing  commit messages. The editor it uses is determined by looking at the environment variables
              HGEDITOR, VISUAL and EDITOR, in that order. The first non-empty one is chosen. If all of them  are
              empty, the editor defaults to 'vi'.

       PYTHONPATH
              This  is  used  by  Python  to  find imported modules and may need to be set appropriately if this
              Mercurial is not installed system-wide.

USING ADDITIONAL FEATURES

       Mercurial has the ability to add new features through the use  of  extensions.  Extensions  may  add  new
       commands, add options to existing commands, change the default behavior of commands, or implement hooks.

       To  enable  the  "foo"  extension,  either shipped with Mercurial or in the Python search path, create an
       entry for it in your configuration file, like this:

       [extensions]
       foo =

       You may also specify the full path to an extension:

       [extensions]
       myfeature = ~/.hgext/myfeature.py

       See hg help config for more information on configuration files.

       Extensions are not loaded by default for a variety of reasons: they can increase startup  overhead;  they
       may  be  meant for advanced usage only; they may provide potentially dangerous abilities (such as letting
       you destroy or modify history); they might not be ready for prime time; or  they  may  alter  some  usual
       behaviors of stock Mercurial. It is thus up to the user to activate extensions as needed.

       To  explicitly  disable  an  extension enabled in a configuration file of broader scope, prepend its path
       with !:

       [extensions]
       # disabling extension bar residing in /path/to/extension/bar.py
       bar = !/path/to/extension/bar.py
       # ditto, but no path was supplied for extension baz
       baz = !

       disabled extensions:

          acl    hooks for controlling repository access

          blackbox
                 log repository events to a blackbox for debugging

          bugzilla
                 hooks for integrating with the Bugzilla bug tracker

          censor erase file content at a given revision

          churn  command to display statistics about repository history

          clonebundles
                 advertise pre-generated bundles to seed clones

          closehead
                 close arbitrary heads without checking them out first

          convert
                 import revisions from foreign VCS repositories into Mercurial

          eol    automatically manage newlines in repository files

          extdiff
                 command to allow external programs to compare revisions

          factotum
                 http authentication with factotum

          githelp
                 try mapping git commands to Mercurial commands

          gpg    commands to sign and verify changesets

          hgk    browse the repository in a graphical way

          highlight
                 syntax highlighting for hgweb (requires Pygments)

          histedit
                 interactive history editing

          keyword
                 expand keywords in tracked files

          largefiles
                 track large binary files

          mq     manage a stack of patches

          notify hooks for sending email push notifications

          patchbomb
                 command to send changesets as (a series of) patch emails

          purge  command to delete untracked files from the working directory

          rebase command to move sets of revisions to a different ancestor

          relink recreates hardlinks between repository clones

          schemes
                 extend schemes with shortcuts to repository swarms

          share  share a common history between several working directories

          strip  strip changesets and their descendants from history

          transplant
                 command to transplant changesets from another branch

          win32mbcs
                 allow the use of MBCS paths with problematic encodings

          zeroconf
                 discover and advertise repositories on the local network

SPECIFYING FILE SETS

       Mercurial supports a functional language for selecting a set of files.

       Like other file patterns, this pattern type is indicated by a prefix, 'set:'.  The  language  supports  a
       number of predicates which are joined by infix operators. Parenthesis can be used for grouping.

       Identifiers  such  as  filenames  or patterns must be quoted with single or double quotes if they contain
       characters outside of [.*{}[]?/\_a-zA-Z0-9\x80-\xff] or if they match one of the  predefined  predicates.
       This  generally  applies to file patterns other than globs and arguments for predicates. Pattern prefixes
       such as path: may be specified without quoting.

       Special characters can be used in quoted identifiers by escaping them,  e.g.,  \n  is  interpreted  as  a
       newline. To prevent them from being interpreted, strings can be prefixed with r, e.g. r'...'.

       See also hg help patterns.

   Operators
       There is a single prefix operator:

       not x

              Files not in x. Short form is ! x.

       These are the supported infix operators:

       x and y

              The intersection of files in x and y. Short form is x & y.

       x or y

              The union of files in x and y. There are two alternative short forms: x | y and x + y.

       x - y

              Files in x but not in y.

   Predicates
       The following predicates are supported:

       added()

              File that is added according to hg status.

       binary()

              File that appears to be binary (contains NUL bytes).

       clean()

              File that is clean according to hg status.

       copied()

              File that is recorded as being copied.

       deleted()

              Alias for missing().

       encoding(name)

              File  can  be  successfully  decoded  with  the  given  character  encoding. May not be useful for
              encodings other than ASCII and UTF-8.

       eol(style)

              File contains newlines of the given style (dos, unix, mac). Binary files are excluded, files  with
              mixed line endings match multiple styles.

       exec()

              File that is marked as executable.

       grep(regex)

              File contains the given regular expression.

       hgignore()

              File that matches the active .hgignore pattern.

       ignored()

              File that is ignored according to hg status.

       missing()

              File that is missing according to hg status.

       modified()

              File that is modified according to hg status.

       portable()

              File that has a portable name. (This doesn't include filenames with case collisions.)

       removed()

              File that is removed according to hg status.

       resolved()

              File that is marked resolved according to hg resolve -l.

       revs(revs, pattern)

              Evaluate  set in the specified revisions. If the revset match multiple revs, this will return file
              matching pattern in any of the revision.

       size(expression)

              File size matches the given expression. Examples:

              • size('1k') - files from 1024 to 2047 bytes

              • size('< 20k') - files less than 20480 bytes

              • size('>= .5MB') - files at least 524288 bytes

              • size('4k - 1MB') - files from 4096 bytes to 1048576 bytes

       status(base, rev, pattern)

              Evaluate predicate using status change between base and rev. Examples:

              • status(3, 7, added()) - matches files added from "3" to "7"

       subrepo([pattern])

              Subrepositories whose paths match the given pattern.

       symlink()

              File that is marked as a symlink.

       tracked()

              File that is under Mercurial control.

       unknown()

              File that is unknown according to hg status.

       unresolved()

              File that is marked unresolved according to hg resolve -l.

   Examples
       Some sample queries:

       • Show status of files that appear to be binary in the working directory:

         hg status -A "set:binary()"

       • Forget files that are in .hgignore but are already tracked:

         hg forget "set:hgignore() and not ignored()"

       • Find text files that contain a string:

         hg files "set:grep(magic) and not binary()"

       • Find C files in a non-standard encoding:

         hg files "set:**.c and not encoding('UTF-8')"

       • Revert copies of large binary files:

         hg revert "set:copied() and binary() and size('>1M')"

       • Revert files that were added to the working directory:

         hg revert "set:revs('wdir()', added())"

       • Remove files listed in foo.lst that contain the letter a or b:

         hg remove "set: listfile:foo.lst and (**a* or **b*)"

COMMAND-LINE FLAGS

       Most Mercurial commands accept various flags.

   Flag names
       Flags for each command are listed in hg  help for  that  command.   Additionally,  some  flags,  such  as
       --repository,  are  global  and  can  be used with any command - those are seen in hg help -v, and can be
       specified before or after the command.

       Every flag has at least a long name, such as --repository. Some flags may also have  a  short  one-letter
       name, such as the equivalent -R. Using the short or long name is equivalent and has the same effect.

       Flags  that  have a short name can also be bundled together - for instance, to specify both --edit (short
       -e) and --interactive (short -i), one could use:

       hg commit -ei

       If any of the bundled flags takes a value (i.e. is not a boolean), it  must  be  last,  followed  by  the
       value:

       hg commit -im 'Message'

   Flag types
       Mercurial command-line flags can be strings, numbers, booleans, or lists of strings.

   Specifying flag values
       The following syntaxes are allowed, assuming a flag 'flagname' with short name 'f':

       --flagname=foo
       --flagname foo
       -f foo
       -ffoo

       This syntax applies to all non-boolean flags (strings, numbers or lists).

   Specifying boolean flags
       Boolean  flags  do not take a value parameter. To specify a boolean, use the flag name to set it to true,
       or the same name prefixed with 'no-' to set it to false:

       hg commit --interactive
       hg commit --no-interactive

   Specifying list flags
       List flags take multiple values. To specify them, pass the flag multiple times:

       hg files --include mercurial --include tests

   Setting flag defaults
       In order to set a default value for a flag in an hgrc file, it is recommended to use aliases:

       [alias]
       commit = commit --interactive

       For more information on hgrc files, see hg help config.

   Overriding flags on the command line
       If the same non-list flag is specified multiple times on the command line, the  latest  specification  is
       used:

       hg commit -m "Ignored value" -m "Used value"

       This includes the use of aliases - e.g., if one has:

       [alias]
       committemp = commit -m "Ignored value"

       then the following command will override that -m:

       hg committemp -m "Used value"

   Overriding flag defaults
       Every  flag  has  a  default  value,  and  you may also set your own defaults in hgrc as described above.
       Except for list flags, defaults can be overridden on the command line simply by specifying  the  flag  in
       that location.

   Hidden flags
       Some  flags  are  not  shown  in  a command's help by default - specifically, those that are deemed to be
       experimental, deprecated or advanced. To show all flags, add the --verbose flag for the help command:

       hg help --verbose commit

GLOSSARY

       Ancestor
              Any changeset that can be reached  by  an  unbroken  chain  of  parent  changesets  from  a  given
              changeset. More precisely, the ancestors of a changeset can be defined by two properties: a parent
              of a changeset is an ancestor, and a parent of an ancestor is an ancestor. See also: 'Descendant'.

       Bookmark
              Bookmarks are pointers to certain commits that move when committing. They are similar to  tags  in
              that  it  is  possible to use bookmark names in all places where Mercurial expects a changeset ID,
              e.g., with hg update. Unlike tags, bookmarks move along when you make a commit.

              Bookmarks can be renamed, copied and deleted. Bookmarks are  local,  unless  they  are  explicitly
              pushed  or  pulled  between  repositories.  Pushing and pulling bookmarks allow you to collaborate
              with others on a branch without creating a named branch.

       Branch (Noun) A child changeset that has been created from a parent that is not a head. These  are  known
              as topological branches, see 'Branch, topological'. If a topological branch is named, it becomes a
              named branch. If a topological branch is not named, it becomes an anonymous branch.  See  'Branch,
              anonymous' and 'Branch, named'.

              Branches  may  be created when changes are pulled from or pushed to a remote repository, since new
              heads may be created by these operations. Note that the term branch can also be used informally to
              describe  a  development  process  in  which  certain  development  is done independently of other
              development. This is sometimes done explicitly with a named  branch,  but  it  can  also  be  done
              locally, using bookmarks or clones and anonymous branches.

              Example: "The experimental branch."

              (Verb)  The  action of creating a child changeset which results in its parent having more than one
              child.

              Example: "I'm going to branch at X."

       Branch, anonymous
              Every time a new child changeset is created from a parent that is not a head and the name  of  the
              branch is not changed, a new anonymous branch is created.

       Branch, closed
              A named branch whose branch heads have all been closed.

       Branch, default
              The branch assigned to a changeset when no name has previously been assigned.

       Branch head
              See 'Head, branch'.

       Branch, inactive
              If  a  named  branch  has  no topological heads, it is considered to be inactive. As an example, a
              feature branch becomes inactive when it is merged into the default branch. The hg branches command
              shows inactive branches by default, though they can be hidden with hg branches --active.

              NOTE:  this  concept  is deprecated because it is too implicit.  Branches should now be explicitly
              closed using hg commit --close-branch when they are no longer needed.

       Branch, named
              A collection of changesets which have the same branch name. By default, children of a changeset in
              a  named branch belong to the same named branch. A child can be explicitly assigned to a different
              branch. See hg help branch, hg help branches and hg commit --close-branch for more information  on
              managing branches.

              Named  branches  can  be  thought of as a kind of namespace, dividing the collection of changesets
              that comprise the repository into a  collection  of  disjoint  subsets.  A  named  branch  is  not
              necessarily  a topological branch. If a new named branch is created from the head of another named
              branch, or the default branch, but no further changesets are added to that previous  branch,  then
              that previous branch will be a branch in name only.

       Branch tip
              See 'Tip, branch'.

       Branch, topological
              Every  time  a  new child changeset is created from a parent that is not a head, a new topological
              branch is created. If a topological branch is named, it becomes a named branch. If  a  topological
              branch is not named, it becomes an anonymous branch of the current, possibly default, branch.

       Changelog
              A  record of the changesets in the order in which they were added to the repository. This includes
              details such as changeset id, author, commit message, date, and list of changed files.

       Changeset
              A snapshot of the state of the repository used to record a change.

       Changeset, child
              The converse of parent changeset: if P is a parent of C, then C is a child of P. There is no limit
              to the number of children that a changeset may have.

       Changeset id
              A  SHA-1  hash  that  uniquely identifies a changeset. It may be represented as either a "long" 40
              hexadecimal digit string, or a "short" 12 hexadecimal digit string.

       Changeset, merge
              A changeset with two parents. This occurs when a merge is committed.

       Changeset, parent
              A revision upon which a child changeset is based. Specifically, a parent changeset of a  changeset
              C  is  a  changeset  whose  node  immediately  precedes  C in the DAG. Changesets have at most two
              parents.

       Checkout
              (Noun) The working directory being updated to a specific revision. This  use  should  probably  be
              avoided where possible, as changeset is much more appropriate than checkout in this context.

              Example: "I'm using checkout X."

              (Verb) Updating the working directory to a specific changeset. See hg help update.

              Example: "I'm going to check out changeset X."

       Child changeset
              See 'Changeset, child'.

       Close changeset
              See 'Head, closed branch'.

       Closed branch
              See 'Branch, closed'.

       Clone  (Noun)  An  entire  or  partial  copy  of a repository. The partial clone must be in the form of a
              revision and its ancestors.

              Example: "Is your clone up to date?"

              (Verb) The process of creating a clone, using hg clone.

              Example: "I'm going to clone the repository."

       Closed branch head
              See 'Head, closed branch'.

       Commit (Noun) A synonym for changeset.

              Example: "Is the bug fixed in your recent commit?"

              (Verb) The act of recording changes to a  repository.  When  files  are  committed  in  a  working
              directory, Mercurial finds the differences between the committed files and their parent changeset,
              creating a new changeset in the repository.

              Example: "You should commit those changes now."

       Cset   A common abbreviation of the term changeset.

       DAG    The repository of changesets of a distributed version control system (DVCS) can be described as  a
              directed  acyclic graph (DAG), consisting of nodes and edges, where nodes correspond to changesets
              and edges imply a parent -> child relation. This graph can be visualized by graphical  tools  such
              as  hg  log  --graph.  In Mercurial, the DAG is limited by the requirement for children to have at
              most two parents.

       Deprecated
              Feature removed from documentation, but not scheduled for removal.

       Default branch
              See 'Branch, default'.

       Descendant
              Any changeset that can be reached by a chain of child changesets  from  a  given  changeset.  More
              precisely,  the  descendants  of  a  changeset  can  be  defined by two properties: the child of a
              changeset is a descendant, and the child of a descendant is a descendant. See also: 'Ancestor'.

       Diff   (Noun) The difference between the contents  and  attributes  of  files  in  two  changesets  or  a
              changeset  and  the current working directory. The difference is usually represented in a standard
              form called a "diff" or "patch". The "git diff" format is used when the  changes  include  copies,
              renames, or changes to file attributes, none of which can be represented/handled by classic "diff"
              and "patch".

              Example: "Did you see my correction in the diff?"

              (Verb) Diffing two changesets is the action of creating a diff or patch.

              Example: "If you diff with changeset X, you will see what I mean."

       Directory, working
              The working directory represents the state of  the  files  tracked  by  Mercurial,  that  will  be
              recorded  in  the  next  commit. The working directory initially corresponds to the snapshot at an
              existing changeset, known as the parent of the working directory. See 'Parent, working directory'.
              The  state  may  be  modified  by  changes  to  the  files  introduced manually or by a merge. The
              repository metadata exists in the .hg directory inside the working directory.

       Draft  Changesets in the draft phase have not been shared with publishing repositories and  may  thus  be
              safely changed by history-modifying extensions. See hg help phases.

       Experimental
              Feature that may change or be removed at a later date.

       Graph  See DAG and hg log --graph.

       Head   The  term 'head' may be used to refer to both a branch head or a repository head, depending on the
              context. See 'Head, branch' and 'Head, repository' for specific definitions.

              Heads are where development generally takes place and are the usual targets for update  and  merge
              operations.

       Head, branch
              A changeset with no descendants on the same named branch.

       Head, closed branch
              A  changeset that marks a head as no longer interesting. The closed head is no longer listed by hg
              heads. A branch is considered closed when all its heads are closed and consequently is not  listed
              by hg branches.

              Closed heads can be re-opened by committing new changeset as the child of the changeset that marks
              a head as closed.

       Head, repository
              A topological head which has not been closed.

       Head, topological
              A changeset with no children in the repository.

       History, immutable
              Once committed, changesets cannot be altered.  Extensions which appear to change history  actually
              create new changesets that replace existing ones, and then destroy the old changesets. Doing so in
              public repositories can result in old changesets being reintroduced to the repository.

       History, rewriting
              The changesets in a repository are immutable. However, extensions to  Mercurial  can  be  used  to
              alter the repository, usually in such a way as to preserve changeset contents.

       Immutable history
              See 'History, immutable'.

       Merge changeset
              See 'Changeset, merge'.

       Manifest
              Each changeset has a manifest, which is the list of files that are tracked by the changeset.

       Merge  Used  to  bring together divergent branches of work. When you update to a changeset and then merge
              another changeset, you bring the history of the latter changeset into your working directory. Once
              conflicts  are  resolved  (and marked), this merge may be committed as a merge changeset, bringing
              two branches together in the DAG.

       Named branch
              See 'Branch, named'.

       Null changeset
              The empty changeset. It is the parent state of  newly-initialized  repositories  and  repositories
              with  no checked out revision. It is thus the parent of root changesets and the effective ancestor
              when merging unrelated changesets. Can be specified by the alias 'null' or  by  the  changeset  ID
              '000000000000'.

       Parent See 'Changeset, parent'.

       Parent changeset
              See 'Changeset, parent'.

       Parent, working directory
              The  working  directory parent reflects a virtual revision which is the child of the changeset (or
              two changesets with an uncommitted merge) shown by hg parents. This is  changed  with  hg  update.
              Other  commands  to see the working directory parent are hg summary and hg id. Can be specified by
              the alias ".".

       Patch  (Noun) The product of a diff operation.

              Example: "I've sent you my patch."

              (Verb) The process of using a patch file to transform one changeset into another.

              Example: "You will need to patch that revision."

       Phase  A per-changeset state tracking how the changeset has been or should be shared. See hg help phases.

       Public Changesets in the public phase have been shared with publishing  repositories  and  are  therefore
              considered immutable. See hg help phases.

       Pull   An  operation in which changesets in a remote repository which are not in the local repository are
              brought into the local repository. Note that this operation without special arguments only updates
              the repository, it does not update the files in the working directory. See hg help pull.

       Push   An  operation  in  which changesets in a local repository which are not in a remote repository are
              sent to the remote repository. Note that this operation  only  adds  changesets  which  have  been
              committed locally to the remote repository. Uncommitted changes are not sent. See hg help push.

       Repository
              The  metadata  describing  all  recorded  states  of a collection of files. Each recorded state is
              represented by a changeset. A repository is usually (but not always) found in the .hg subdirectory
              of a working directory. Any recorded state can be recreated by "updating" a working directory to a
              specific changeset.

       Repository head
              See 'Head, repository'.

       Revision
              A state of the repository at some point in time. Earlier revisions can be updated to by  using  hg
              update.  See also 'Revision number'; See also 'Changeset'.

       Revision number
              This  integer uniquely identifies a changeset in a specific repository. It represents the order in
              which changesets were added to a repository, starting  with  revision  number  0.  Note  that  the
              revision  number  may  be different in each clone of a repository. To identify changesets uniquely
              between different clones, see 'Changeset id'.

       Revlog History storage mechanism used by Mercurial. It is a form of delta encoding, with occasional  full
              revision  of  data  followed  by  delta of each successive revision. It includes data and an index
              pointing to the data.

       Rewriting history
              See 'History, rewriting'.

       Root   A changeset that has only the null changeset as its parent. Most repositories have only  a  single
              root changeset.

       Secret Changesets in the secret phase may not be shared via push, pull, or clone. See hg help phases.

       Tag    An alternative name given to a changeset. Tags can be used in all places where Mercurial expects a
              changeset ID, e.g., with hg update. The creation of a tag is stored in the history and  will  thus
              automatically be shared with other using push and pull.

       Tip    The  changeset  with  the  highest  revision  number. It is the changeset most recently added in a
              repository.

       Tip, branch
              The head of a given branch with the highest revision number. When a  branch  name  is  used  as  a
              revision  identifier,  it  refers  to  the  branch tip. See also 'Branch, head'. Note that because
              revision numbers may be different in different repository clones, the branch tip may be  different
              in different cloned repositories.

       Update (Noun) Another synonym of changeset.

              Example: "I've pushed an update."

              (Verb)  This  term is usually used to describe updating the state of the working directory to that
              of a specific changeset. See hg help update.

              Example: "You should update."

       Working directory
              See 'Directory, working'.

       Working directory parent
              See 'Parent, working directory'.

SYNTAX FOR MERCURIAL IGNORE FILES

   Synopsis
       The Mercurial system uses a file called .hgignore in the root directory of a repository  to  control  its
       behavior when it searches for files that it is not currently tracking.

   Description
       The  working  directory  of a Mercurial repository will often contain files that should not be tracked by
       Mercurial. These include backup files created by editors and build products created by compilers.   These
       files  can  be  ignored  by  listing  them  in a .hgignore file in the root of the working directory. The
       .hgignore file must be created manually. It is typically put under version control, so that the  settings
       will propagate to other repositories with push and pull.

       An untracked file is ignored if its path relative to the repository root directory, or any prefix path of
       that path, is matched against any pattern in .hgignore.

       For example, say we have an untracked file, file.c, at a/b/file.c inside our repository.  Mercurial  will
       ignore file.c if any pattern in .hgignore matches a/b/file.c, a/b or a.

       In  addition,  a Mercurial configuration file can reference a set of per-user or global ignore files. See
       the ignore configuration key on the [ui] section of hg help config for details of how to configure  these
       files.

       To  control  Mercurial's  handling of files that it manages, many commands support the -I and -X options;
       see hg help <command> and hg help patterns for details.

       Files that are already tracked are not affected by .hgignore,  even  if  they  appear  in  .hgignore.  An
       untracked  file  X  can  be  explicitly  added with hg add X, even if X would be excluded by a pattern in
       .hgignore.

   Syntax
       An ignore file is a plain text file consisting of a list of patterns, with one pattern  per  line.  Empty
       lines  are  skipped. The # character is treated as a comment character, and the \ character is treated as
       an escape character.

       Mercurial supports several pattern  syntaxes.  The  default  syntax  used  is  Python/Perl-style  regular
       expressions.

       To change the syntax used, use a line of the following form:

       syntax: NAME

       where NAME is one of the following:

       regexp

              Regular expression, Python/Perl syntax.

       glob

              Shell-style glob.

       rootglob

              A variant of glob that is rooted (see below).

       The  chosen  syntax  stays  in  effect  when  parsing  all  patterns that follow, until another syntax is
       selected.

       Neither glob nor regexp patterns are rooted. A glob-syntax pattern of the form  *.c  will  match  a  file
       ending  in  .c in any directory, and a regexp pattern of the form \.c$ will do the same. To root a regexp
       pattern, start it with ^. To get the same effect with glob-syntax, you have to use rootglob.

       Subdirectories can have their own .hgignore settings by adding subinclude:path/to/subdir/.hgignore to the
       root .hgignore. See hg help patterns for details on subinclude: and include:.

       Note   Patterns  specified  in  other  than .hgignore are always rooted.  Please see hg help patterns for
              details.

   Example
       Here is an example ignore file.

       # use glob syntax.
       syntax: glob

       *.elc
       *.pyc
       *~

       # switch to regexp syntax.
       syntax: regexp
       ^\.pc/

CONFIGURING HGWEB

       Mercurial's internal web server, hgweb, can serve either a single repository, or a tree of  repositories.
       In  the  second  case, repository paths and global options can be defined using a dedicated configuration
       file common to hg serve, hgweb.wsgi, hgweb.cgi and hgweb.fcgi.

       This file uses the same syntax as other Mercurial configuration files but recognizes only  the  following
       sections:

          • web

          • paths

          • collections

       The web options are thoroughly described in hg help config.

       The  paths  section  maps URL paths to paths of repositories in the filesystem. hgweb will not expose the
       filesystem  directly  -  only  Mercurial  repositories  can  be  published  and  only  according  to  the
       configuration.

       The  left hand side is the path in the URL. Note that hgweb reserves subpaths like rev or file, try using
       different names for nested repositories to avoid confusing effects.

       The right hand side is the path in the filesystem. If the specified path ends with * or ** the filesystem
       will  be  searched  recursively  for  repositories below that point.  With * it will not recurse into the
       repositories it finds (except for .hg/patches).  With ** it will also search  inside  repository  working
       directories and possibly find subrepositories.

       In this example:

       [paths]
       /projects/a = /srv/tmprepos/a
       /projects/b = c:/repos/b
       / = /srv/repos/*
       /user/bob = /home/bob/repos/**

       • The first two entries make two repositories in different directories appear under the same directory in
         the web interface

       • The third entry will publish  every  Mercurial  repository  found  in  /srv/repos/,  for  instance  the
         repository /srv/repos/quux/ will appear as http://server/quux/

       • The       fourth      entry      will      publish      both      http://server/user/bob/quux/      and
         http://server/user/bob/quux/testsubrepo/

       The collections section is deprecated and has been superseded by paths.

   URLs and Common Arguments
       URLs under each repository have the form /{command}[/{arguments}] where {command} represents the name  of
       a command or handler and {arguments} represents any number of additional URL parameters to that command.

       The  web  server  has  a default style associated with it. Styles map to a collection of named templates.
       Each template is used to render a specific piece of data, such as a changeset or diff.

       The style for the current request can be overridden two ways. First, if {command} contains a hyphen  (-),
       the  text before the hyphen defines the style. For example, /atom-log will render the log command handler
       with the atom style. The second way to set the style  is  with  the  style  query  string  argument.  For
       example, /log?style=atom. The hyphenated URL parameter is preferred.

       Not all templates are available for all styles. Attempting to use a style that doesn't have all templates
       defined may result in an error rendering the page.

       Many commands take a {revision} URL parameter. This defines the changeset to operate on. This is commonly
       specified  as  the  short,  12  digit  hexadecimal abbreviation for the full 40 character unique revision
       identifier. However, any value described by hg help revisions typically works.

   Commands and URLs
       The following web commands and their URLs are available:

   /annotate/{revision}/{path}
       Show changeset information for each line in a file.

       The ignorews, ignorewsamount, ignorewseol, and ignoreblanklines query  string  arguments  have  the  same
       meaning  as  their [annotate] config equivalents. It uses the hgrc boolean parsing logic to interpret the
       value. e.g. 0 and false are false and 1 and true are true. If not defined, the  server  default  settings
       are used.

       The fileannotate template is rendered.

   /archive/{revision}.{format}[/{path}]
       Obtain an archive of repository content.

       The  content and type of the archive is defined by a URL path parameter.  format is the file extension of
       the archive type to be generated. e.g.  zip or tar.bz2. Not all archive types  may  be  allowed  by  your
       server configuration.

       The optional path URL parameter controls content to include in the archive. If omitted, every file in the
       specified revision is present in the archive. If included, only the specified file  or  contents  of  the
       specified directory will be included in the archive.

       No template is used for this handler. Raw, binary content is generated.

   /bookmarks
       Show information about bookmarks.

       No arguments are accepted.

       The bookmarks template is rendered.

   /branches
       Show information about branches.

       All known branches are contained in the output, even closed branches.

       No arguments are accepted.

       The branches template is rendered.

   /changelog[/{revision}]
       Show information about multiple changesets.

       If the optional revision URL argument is absent, information about all changesets starting at tip will be
       rendered. If the revision argument is present, changesets will  be  shown  starting  from  the  specified
       revision.

       If  revision  is  absent,  the  rev  query string argument may be defined. This will perform a search for
       changesets.

       The argument for rev can be a single revision, a revision set, or a literal  keyword  to  search  for  in
       changeset data (equivalent to hg log -k).

       The revcount query string argument defines the maximum numbers of changesets to render.

       For non-searches, the changelog template will be rendered.

   /changeset[/{revision}]
       Show information about a single changeset.

       A  URL  path  argument is the changeset identifier to show. See hg help revisions for possible values. If
       not defined, the tip changeset will be shown.

       The changeset template is  rendered.  Contents  of  the  changesettag,  changesetbookmark,  filenodelink,
       filenolink, and the many templates related to diffs may all be used to produce the output.

   /comparison/{revision}/{path}
       Show a comparison between the old and new versions of a file from changes made on a particular revision.

       This is similar to the diff handler. However, this form features a split or side-by-side diff rather than
       a unified diff.

       The context query string argument can be used to control the lines of context in the diff.

       The filecomparison template is rendered.

   /diff/{revision}/{path}
       Show how a file changed in a particular commit.

       The filediff template is rendered.

       This handler is registered under both the /diff and /filediff paths. /diff is used in modern code.

   /file/{revision}[/{path}]
       Show information about a directory or file in the repository.

       Info about the path given as a URL parameter will be rendered.

       If path is a directory, information about the entries in that directory will be rendered.  This  form  is
       equivalent to the manifest handler.

       If path is a file, information about that file will be shown via the filerevision template.

       If path is not defined, information about the root directory will be rendered.

   /diff/{revision}/{path}
       Show how a file changed in a particular commit.

       The filediff template is rendered.

       This handler is registered under both the /diff and /filediff paths. /diff is used in modern code.

   /filelog/{revision}/{path}
       Show information about the history of a file in the repository.

       The revcount query string argument can be defined to control the maximum number of entries to show.

       The filelog template will be rendered.

   /graph[/{revision}]
       Show information about the graphical topology of the repository.

       Information rendered by this handler can be used to create visual representations of repository topology.

       The revision URL parameter controls the starting changeset. If it's absent, the default is tip.

       The revcount query string argument can define the number of changesets to show information for.

       The  graphtop query string argument can specify the starting changeset for producing jsdata variable that
       is used for rendering graph in JavaScript. By default it has the same value as revision.

       This handler will render the graph template.

   /help[/{topic}]
       Render help documentation.

       This web command is roughly equivalent to hg help. If a  topic  is  defined,  that  help  topic  will  be
       rendered. If not, an index of available help topics will be rendered.

       The help template will be rendered when requesting help for a topic.  helptopics will be rendered for the
       index of help topics.

   /log[/{revision}[/{path}]]
       Show repository or file history.

       For URLs of the form /log/{revision}, a list of changesets starting at the specified changeset identifier
       is  shown.  If  {revision}  is  not defined, the default is tip. This form is equivalent to the changelog
       handler.

       For URLs of the form /log/{revision}/{file}, the history for a specific file will be shown. This form  is
       equivalent to the filelog handler.

   /manifest[/{revision}[/{path}]]
       Show information about a directory.

       If the URL path arguments are omitted, information about the root directory for the tip changeset will be
       shown.

       Because this handler can only show information for directories, it is recommended to use the file handler
       instead, as it can handle both directories and files.

       The manifest template will be rendered for this handler.

   /changeset[/{revision}]
       Show information about a single changeset.

       A  URL  path  argument is the changeset identifier to show. See hg help revisions for possible values. If
       not defined, the tip changeset will be shown.

       The changeset template is  rendered.  Contents  of  the  changesettag,  changesetbookmark,  filenodelink,
       filenolink, and the many templates related to diffs may all be used to produce the output.

   /shortlog
       Show basic information about a set of changesets.

       This  accepts  the same parameters as the changelog handler. The only difference is the shortlog template
       will be rendered instead of the changelog template.

   /summary
       Show a summary of repository state.

       Information about the latest changesets, bookmarks, tags, and branches is captured by this handler.

       The summary template is rendered.

   /tags
       Show information about tags.

       No arguments are accepted.

       The tags template is rendered.

TECHNICAL IMPLEMENTATION TOPICS

       To access a subtopic, use "hg help internals.{subtopic-name}"

          bundle2
                 Bundle2

          bundles
                 Bundles

          cbor   CBOR

          censor Censor

          changegroups
                 Changegroups

          config Config Registrar

          extensions
                 Extension API

          mergestate
                 Mergestate

          requirements
                 Repository Requirements

          revlogs
                 Revision Logs

          wireprotocol
                 Wire Protocol

          wireprotocolrpc
                 Wire Protocol RPC

          wireprotocolv2
                 Wire Protocol Version 2

MERGE TOOLS

       To merge files Mercurial uses merge tools.

       A merge tool combines two different versions of a file into a merged file. Merge tools are given the  two
       files  and  the greatest common ancestor of the two file versions, so they can determine the changes made
       on both branches.

       Merge tools are used both for hg resolve, hg merge, hg update, hg backout and in several extensions.

       Usually, the merge tool tries to automatically reconcile  the  files  by  combining  all  non-overlapping
       changes  that  occurred  separately  in  the  two  different  evolutions  of  the same initial base file.
       Furthermore, some interactive merge programs make it  easier  to  manually  resolve  conflicting  merges,
       either  in  a  graphical  way,  or  by  inserting  some  conflict markers. Mercurial does not include any
       interactive merge programs but relies on external tools for that.

   Available merge tools
       External merge tools and their properties are configured in the merge-tools configuration section  -  see
       hgrc(5) - but they can often just be named by their executable.

       A  merge  tool  is generally usable if its executable can be found on the system and if it can handle the
       merge. The executable is found if it is an absolute or  relative  executable  path  or  the  name  of  an
       application  in  the executable search path. The tool is assumed to be able to handle the merge if it can
       handle symlinks if the file is a symlink, if it can handle binary files if the file is binary, and  if  a
       GUI is available if the tool requires a GUI.

       There are some internal merge tools which can be used. The internal merge tools are:

       :dump

              Creates  three  versions  of the files to merge, containing the contents of local, other and base.
              These files can then be used to perform a merge manually. If the file to be merged is named a.txt,
              these  files  will  accordingly  be named a.txt.local, a.txt.other and a.txt.base and they will be
              placed in the same directory as a.txt.

              This implies premerge.  Therefore,  files  aren't  dumped,  if  premerge  runs  successfully.  Use
              :forcedump to forcibly write files out.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :fail

              Rather  than  attempting  to  merge  files  that  were modified on both branches, it marks them as
              unresolved. The resolve command must be used to resolve these conflicts.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :forcedump

              Creates three versions of the files as same as :dump, but omits premerge.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :local

              Uses the local p1() version of files as the merged version.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :merge

              Uses the internal non-interactive simple merge algorithm for merging files. It will fail if  there
              are  any conflicts and leave markers in the partially merged file. Markers will have two sections,
              one for each side of merge.

       :merge-local

              Like :merge, but resolve all conflicts non-interactively in favor of the local p1() changes.

       :merge-other

              Like :merge, but resolve all conflicts non-interactively in favor of the other p2() changes.

       :merge3

              Uses the internal non-interactive simple merge algorithm for merging files. It will fail if  there
              are any conflicts and leave markers in the partially merged file. Marker will have three sections,
              one from each side of the merge and one for the base content.

       :other

              Uses the other p2() version of files as the merged version.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :prompt

              Asks the user which of the local p1() or the other p2() version to keep as the merged version.

              (actual capabilities: binary, symlink)

       :tagmerge

              Uses the internal tag merge algorithm (experimental).

       :union

              Uses the internal non-interactive simple merge algorithm for merging files. It will use both  left
              and right sides for conflict regions.  No markers are inserted.

       Internal  tools  are always available and do not require a GUI but will by default not handle symlinks or
       binary files. See next section for detail about "actual capabilities" described above.

   Choosing a merge tool
       Mercurial uses these rules when deciding which merge tool to use:

       1. If a tool has been specified with the --tool option to merge or resolve, it is used.   If  it  is  the
          name  of  a  tool in the merge-tools configuration, its configuration is used. Otherwise the specified
          tool must be executable by the shell.

       2. If the HGMERGE environment variable is present, its value is used and must be executable by the shell.

       3. If the filename of the  file  to  be  merged  matches  any  of  the  patterns  in  the  merge-patterns
          configuration section, the first usable merge tool corresponding to a matching pattern is used.

       4. If  ui.merge is set it will be considered next. If the value is not the name of a configured tool, the
          specified value is used and must be executable by the shell. Otherwise the named tool is used if it is
          usable.

       5. If  any  usable  merge  tools  are  present in the merge-tools configuration section, the one with the
          highest priority is used.

       6. If a program named hgmerge can be found on the system, it is used - but it will by default not be used
          for symlinks and binary files.

       7. If the file to be merged is not binary and is not a symlink, then internal :merge is used.

       8. Otherwise, :prompt is used.

       For historical reason, Mercurial treats merge tools as below while examining rules above.

                                   ┌───────────┬────────────────┬────────┬─────────┐
                                   │step       │ specified via  │ binary │ symlink │
                                   ├───────────┼────────────────┼────────┼─────────┤
                                   │           │ --tool         │ o/o    │ o/o     │
                                   │       1.  │                │        │         │
                                   ├───────────┼────────────────┼────────┼─────────┤
                                   │           │ HGMERGE        │ o/o    │ o/o     │
                                   │       2.  │                │        │         │
                                   ├───────────┼────────────────┼────────┼─────────┤
                                   │           │ merge-patterns │ o/o(*) │ x/?(*)  │
                                   │       3.  │                │        │         │
                                   ├───────────┼────────────────┼────────┼─────────┤
                                   │           │ ui.merge       │ x/?(*) │ x/?(*)  │
                                   │       4.  │                │        │         │
                                   └───────────┴────────────────┴────────┴─────────┘

       Each  capability  column indicates Mercurial behavior for internal/external merge tools at examining each
       rule.

       • "o": "assume that a tool has capability"

       • "x": "assume that a tool does not have capability"

       • "?": "check actual capability of a tool"

       If merge.strict-capability-check configuration is true, Mercurial  checks  capabilities  of  merge  tools
       strictly in (*) cases above (= each capability column becomes "?/?"). It is false by default for backward
       compatibility.

       Note   After selecting a merge program, Mercurial will by default attempt to  merge  the  files  using  a
              simple  merge  algorithm  first.  Only  if  it doesn't succeed because of conflicting changes will
              Mercurial actually execute the merge program. Whether to use the simple merge algorithm first  can
              be controlled by the premerge setting of the merge tool. Premerge is enabled by default unless the
              file is binary or a symlink.

       See the merge-tools and ui sections of hgrc(5) for details on the configuration of merge tools.

PAGER SUPPORT

       Some Mercurial commands can produce a lot of output, and Mercurial will attempt to use a  pager  to  make
       those commands more pleasant.

       To set the pager that should be used, set the application variable:

       [pager]
       pager = less -FRX

       If  no  pager  is  set  in  the user or repository configuration, Mercurial uses the environment variable
       $PAGER. If $PAGER is not set, pager.pager from the default or system configuration is used.  If  none  of
       these are set, a default pager will be used, typically less on Unix and more on Windows.

       On  Windows,  more  is  not  color aware, so using it effectively disables color.  MSYS and Cygwin shells
       provide less  as  a  pager,  which  can  be  configured  to  support  ANSI  color  codes.   See  hg  help
       config.color.pagermode to configure the color mode when invoking a pager.

       You can disable the pager for certain commands by adding them to the pager.ignore list:

       [pager]
       ignore = version, help, update

       To ignore global commands like hg version or hg help, you have to specify them in your user configuration
       file.

       To control whether the pager is used at all for an individual command, you can use --pager=<value>:

          • use as needed: auto.

          • require the pager: yes or on.

          • suppress the pager: no or off (any unrecognized value will also work).

       To globally turn off all attempts to use a pager, set:

       [ui]
       paginate = never

       which will prevent the pager from running.

FILE NAME PATTERNS

       Mercurial accepts several notations for identifying one or more files at a time.

       By default, Mercurial treats filenames as shell-style extended glob patterns.

       Alternate pattern notations must be specified explicitly.

       Note   Patterns specified in .hgignore are not rooted.  Please see hg help hgignore for details.

       To use a plain path name without any pattern matching,  start  it  with  path:.  These  path  names  must
       completely  match starting at the current repository root, and when the path points to a directory, it is
       matched recursively. To match all files in a  directory  non-recursively  (not  including  any  files  in
       subdirectories), rootfilesin: can be used, specifying an absolute path (relative to the repository root).

       To  use an extended glob, start a name with glob:. Globs are rooted at the current directory; a glob such
       as *.c will only match files in the current directory ending with .c. rootglob: can be  used  instead  of
       glob: for a glob that is rooted at the root of the repository.

       The  supported glob syntax extensions are ** to match any string across path separators and {a,b} to mean
       "a or b".

       To use a Perl/Python regular expression, start a name with re:.  Regexp pattern matching is  anchored  at
       the root of the repository.

       To  read  name  patterns  from  a  file,  use listfile: or listfile0:.  The latter expects null delimited
       patterns while the former expects line feeds. Each string read from the file is itself treated as a  file
       pattern.

       To  read  a set of patterns from a file, use include: or subinclude:.  include: will use all the patterns
       from the given file and treat them as if they had been passed in manually.  subinclude: will  only  apply
       the  patterns  against  files  that  are  under the subinclude file's directory. See hg help hgignore for
       details on the format of these files.

       All patterns, except for glob: specified in command line (not for -I  or  -X  options),  can  match  also
       against  directories:  files  under  matched  directories are treated as matched.  For -I and -X options,
       glob: will match directories recursively.

       Plain examples:

       path:foo/bar        a name bar in a directory named foo in the root
                           of the repository
       path:path:name      a file or directory named "path:name"
       rootfilesin:foo/bar the files in a directory called foo/bar, but not any files
                           in its subdirectories and not a file bar in directory foo

       Glob examples:

       glob:*.c       any name ending in ".c" in the current directory
       *.c            any name ending in ".c" in the current directory
       **.c           any name ending in ".c" in any subdirectory of the
                      current directory including itself.
       foo/*          any file in directory foo
       foo/**         any file in directory foo plus all its subdirectories,
                      recursively
       foo/*.c        any name ending in ".c" in the directory foo
       foo/**.c       any name ending in ".c" in any subdirectory of foo
                      including itself.
       rootglob:*.c   any name ending in ".c" in the root of the repository

       Regexp examples:

       re:.*\.c$      any name ending in ".c", anywhere in the repository

       File examples:

       listfile:list.txt  read list from list.txt with one file pattern per line
       listfile0:list.txt read list from list.txt with null byte delimiters

       See also hg help filesets.

       Include examples:

       include:path/to/mypatternfile    reads patterns to be applied to all paths
       subinclude:path/to/subignorefile reads patterns specifically for paths in the
                                        subdirectory

WORKING WITH PHASES

   What are phases?
       Phases are a system for tracking which changesets have been or  should  be  shared.  This  helps  prevent
       common mistakes when modifying history (for instance, with the mq or rebase extensions).

       Each changeset in a repository is in one of the following phases:

          • public : changeset is visible on a public server

          • draft : changeset is not yet published

          • secret : changeset should not be pushed, pulled, or cloned

       These  phases  are  ordered  (public  < draft < secret) and no changeset can be in a lower phase than its
       ancestors. For instance, if a changeset is public, all its ancestors are also public.  Lastly,  changeset
       phases should only be changed towards the public phase.

   How are phases managed?
       For  the  most  part,  phases  should work transparently. By default, a changeset is created in the draft
       phase and is moved into the public phase when it is pushed to another repository.

       Once changesets become public, extensions like mq and rebase will refuse to operate on  them  to  prevent
       creating  duplicate  changesets.   Phases  can  also be manually manipulated with the hg phase command if
       needed. See hg help -v phase for examples.

       To make your commits secret by default, put this in your configuration file:

       [phases]
       new-commit = secret

   Phases and servers
       Normally, all servers are publishing by default. This means:

       - all draft changesets that are pulled or cloned appear in phase
       public on the client

       - all draft changesets that are pushed appear as public on both
       client and server

       - secret changesets are neither pushed, pulled, or cloned

       Note   Pulling a draft changeset from a publishing server does not mark it as public on the  server  side
              due to the read-only nature of pull.

       Sometimes  it  may  be desirable to push and pull changesets in the draft phase to share unfinished work.
       This can be done by setting a repository to disable publishing in its configuration file:

       [phases]
       publish = False

       See hg help config for more information on configuration files.

       Note   Servers running older versions of Mercurial are treated as publishing.

       Note   Changesets in secret phase are not exchanged with the server. This applies to their content:  file
              names,  file  contents,  and  changeset  metadata.  For  technical  reasons,  the identifier (e.g.
              d825e4025e39) of the secret changeset may be communicated to the server.

   Examples
          • list changesets in draft or secret phase:

            hg log -r "not public()"

          • change all secret changesets to draft:

            hg phase --draft "secret()"

          • forcibly move the current changeset and descendants from public to draft:

            hg phase --force --draft .

          • show a list of changeset revisions and each corresponding phase:

            hg log --template "{rev} {phase}\n"

          • resynchronize draft changesets relative to a remote repository:

            hg phase -fd "outgoing(URL)"

       See hg help phase for more information on manually manipulating phases.

SPECIFYING REVISIONS

       Mercurial supports several ways to specify revisions.

   Specifying single revisions
       A plain integer is treated as a revision number. Negative integers are treated as sequential offsets from
       the tip, with -1 denoting the tip, -2 denoting the revision prior to the tip, and so forth.

       A 40-digit hexadecimal string is treated as a unique revision identifier.  A hexadecimal string less than
       40 characters long is treated as a unique  revision  identifier  and  is  referred  to  as  a  short-form
       identifier.  A  short-form  identifier  is  only  valid  if  it  is the prefix of exactly one full-length
       identifier.

       Any other string is treated as a bookmark, tag, or branch name. A bookmark is  a  movable  pointer  to  a
       revision.  A  tag  is a permanent name associated with a revision. A branch name denotes the tipmost open
       branch head of that branch - or if they are all closed, the tipmost closed head of the branch.  Bookmark,
       tag, and branch names must not contain the ":" character.

       The reserved name "tip" always identifies the most recent revision.

       The  reserved  name  "null" indicates the null revision. This is the revision of an empty repository, and
       the parent of revision 0.

       The reserved name "." indicates the working directory parent. If no working directory is checked out,  it
       is equivalent to null. If an uncommitted merge is in progress, "." is the revision of the first parent.

       Finally,  commands  that  expect  a  single  revision (like hg update) also accept revsets (see below for
       details). When given a revset, they use the last revision of the revset. A few commands accept two single
       revisions (like hg diff). When given a revset, they use the first and the last revisions of the revset.

   Specifying multiple revisions
       Mercurial  supports  a functional language for selecting a set of revisions. Expressions in this language
       are called revsets.

       The language supports a number of predicates which are joined by infix operators. Parenthesis can be used
       for grouping.

       Identifiers such as branch names may need quoting with single or double quotes if they contain characters
       like - or if they match one of the predefined predicates.

       Special characters can be used in quoted identifiers by escaping them,  e.g.,  \n  is  interpreted  as  a
       newline. To prevent them from being interpreted, strings can be prefixed with r, e.g. r'...'.

   Operators
       There is a single prefix operator:

       not x

              Changesets not in x. Short form is ! x.

       These are the supported infix operators:

       x::y

              A  DAG range, meaning all changesets that are descendants of x and ancestors of y, including x and
              y themselves. If the first endpoint is left out, this is equivalent to ancestors(y), if the second
              is left out it is equivalent to descendants(x).

              An alternative syntax is x..y.

       x:y

              All  changesets with revision numbers between x and y, both inclusive. Either endpoint can be left
              out, they default to 0 and tip.

       x and y

              The intersection of changesets in x and y. Short form is x & y.

       x or y

              The union of changesets in x and y. There are two alternative short forms: x | y and x + y.

       x - y

              Changesets in x but not in y.

       x % y

              Changesets that are ancestors of x but not ancestors of y (i.e. ::x -  ::y).   This  is  shorthand
              notation  for  only(x,  y)  (see  below).  The  second  argument  is optional and, if left out, is
              equivalent to only(x).

       x^n

              The nth parent of x, n == 0, 1, or 2.  For n == 0, x; for  n  ==  1,  the  first  parent  of  each
              changeset in x; for n == 2, the second parent of changeset in x.

       x~n

              The  nth first ancestor of x; x~0 is x; x~3 is x^^^.  For n < 0, the nth unambiguous descendent of
              x.

       x ## y

              Concatenate strings and identifiers into one string.

              All other prefix, infix and postfix operators have lower priority than ##. For example, a1 ## a2~2
              is equivalent to (a1 ## a2)~2.

              For example:

              [revsetalias]
              issue(a1) = grep(r'\bissue[ :]?' ## a1 ## r'\b|\bbug\(' ## a1 ## r'\)')

              issue(1234)  is equivalent to grep(r'\bissue[ :]?1234\b|\bbug\(1234\)') in this case. This matches
              against all of "issue 1234", "issue:1234", "issue1234" and "bug(1234)".

       There is a single postfix operator:

       x^

              Equivalent to x^1, the first parent of each changeset in x.

   Patterns
       Where noted, predicates that perform string matching can accept a pattern  string.  The  pattern  may  be
       either  a  literal, or a regular expression. If the pattern starts with re:, the remainder of the pattern
       is treated as a regular expression. Otherwise, it is treated as  a  literal.  To  match  a  pattern  that
       actually starts with re:, use the prefix literal:.

       Matching  is  case-sensitive,  unless  otherwise  noted.   To  perform  a  case-  insensitive  match on a
       case-sensitive predicate, use a regular expression, prefixed with (?i).

       For example, tag(r're:(?i)release') matches "release" or "RELEASE" or "Release", etc.

   Predicates
       The following predicates are supported:

       adds(pattern)

              Changesets that add a file matching pattern.

              The pattern without explicit kind like glob: is expected to be relative to the  current  directory
              and match against a file or a directory.

       all()

              All changesets, the same as 0:tip.

       ancestor(*changeset)

              A greatest common ancestor of the changesets.

              Accepts  0  or  more  changesets.   Will  return  empty list when passed no args.  Greatest common
              ancestor of a single changeset is that changeset.

       ancestors(set[, depth])

              Changesets that are ancestors of changesets in set, including the given changesets themselves.

              If depth is specified, the result only includes changesets up to the specified generation.

       author(string)

              Alias for user(string).

       bisect(string)

              Changesets marked in the specified bisect status:

              • good, bad, skip: csets explicitly marked as good/bad/skip

              • goods, bads      : csets topologically good/bad

              • range              : csets taking part in the bisection

              • pruned             : csets that are goods, bads or skipped

              • untested           : csets whose fate is yet unknown

              • ignored            : csets ignored due to DAG topology

              • current            : the cset currently being bisected

       bookmark([name])

              The named bookmark or all bookmarks.

              Pattern matching is supported for name. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       branch(string or set)

              All changesets belonging to the given branch or the branches of the given changesets.

              Pattern matching is supported for string. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       branchpoint()

              Changesets with more than one child.

       bundle()

              Changesets in the bundle.

              Bundle must be specified by the -R option.

       children(set)

              Child changesets of changesets in set.

       closed()

              Changeset is closed.

       commonancestors(set)

              Changesets that are ancestors of every changeset in set.

       contains(pattern)

              The revision's manifest contains a file matching pattern (but might not modify it).  See  hg  help
              patterns for information about file patterns.

              The  pattern  without explicit kind like glob: is expected to be relative to the current directory
              and match against a file exactly for efficiency.

       converted([id])

              Changesets converted from the given identifier in the old repository if present, or all  converted
              changesets if no identifier is specified.

       date(interval)

              Changesets within the interval, see hg help dates.

       desc(string)

              Search commit message for string. The match is case-insensitive.

              Pattern matching is supported for string. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       descendants(set[, depth])

              Changesets which are descendants of changesets in set, including the given changesets themselves.

              If depth is specified, the result only includes changesets up to the specified generation.

       destination([set])

              Changesets  that were created by a graft, transplant or rebase operation, with the given revisions
              specified as the source.  Omitting the optional set is the same as passing all().

       draft()

              Changeset in draft phase.

       expectsize(set[, size])

              Return the given revset if size matches the revset size.  Abort if the revset doesn't expect given
              size.  size can either be an integer range or an integer.

              For  example,  expectsize(0:1,  3:5)  will  abort as revset size is 2 and 2 is not between 3 and 5
              inclusive.

       extinct()

              Obsolete changesets with obsolete descendants only.

       extra(label, [value])

              Changesets with the given label in the extra metadata, with the given optional value.

              Pattern matching is supported for value. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       file(pattern)

              Changesets affecting files matched by pattern.

              For a faster but less accurate result, consider using filelog() instead.

              This predicate uses glob: as the default kind of pattern.

       filelog(pattern)

              Changesets connected to the specified filelog.

              For performance reasons, visits only revisions mentioned in the file-level  filelog,  rather  than
              filtering  through all changesets (much faster, but doesn't include deletes or duplicate changes).
              For a slower, more accurate result, use file().

              The pattern without explicit kind like glob: is expected to be relative to the  current  directory
              and match against a file exactly for efficiency.

       first(set, [n])

              An alias for limit().

       follow([file[, startrev]])

              An  alias  for  ::.  (ancestors  of  the  working  directory's  first parent).  If file pattern is
              specified, the histories of files matching given pattern in the revision  given  by  startrev  are
              followed, including copies.

       followlines(file, fromline:toline[, startrev=., descend=False])

              Changesets modifying file in line range ('fromline', 'toline').

              Line  range  corresponds  to 'file' content at 'startrev' and should hence be consistent with file
              size. If startrev is not specified, working directory's parent is used.

              By default, ancestors of 'startrev' are returned. If 'descend' is True, descendants of  'startrev'
              are returned though renames are (currently) not followed in this direction.

       grep(regex)

              Like keyword(string) but accepts a regex. Use grep(r'...') to ensure special escape characters are
              handled correctly. Unlike keyword(string), the match is case-sensitive.

       head()

              Changeset is a named branch head.

       heads(set)

              Members of set with no children in set.

       hidden()

              Hidden changesets.

       id(string)

              Revision non-ambiguously specified by the given hex string prefix.

       keyword(string)

              Search commit  message,  user  name,  and  names  of  changed  files  for  string.  The  match  is
              case-insensitive.

              For a regular expression or case sensitive search of these fields, use grep(regex).

       last(set, [n])

              Last n members of set, defaulting to 1.

       limit(set[, n[, offset]])

              First n members of set, defaulting to 1, starting from offset.

       matching(revision [, field])

              Changesets in which a given set of fields match the set of fields in the selected revision or set.

              To  match  more  than  one field pass the list of fields to match separated by spaces (e.g. author
              description).

              Valid fields are most regular revision fields and some special fields.

              Regular revision fields are description, author, branch, date, files,  phase,  parents,  substate,
              user  and  diff.   Note  that  author  and  user  are synonyms. diff refers to the contents of the
              revision. Two revisions matching their diff will also match their files.

              Special fields are summary and metadata: summary  matches  the  first  line  of  the  description.
              metadata  is  equivalent  to  matching  description  user  date (i.e. it matches the main metadata
              fields).

              metadata is the default field which is used when no fields are specified. You can match more  than
              one field at a time.

       max(set)

              Changeset with highest revision number in set.

       merge()

              Changeset is a merge changeset.

       min(set)

              Changeset with lowest revision number in set.

       modifies(pattern)

              Changesets modifying files matched by pattern.

              The  pattern  without explicit kind like glob: is expected to be relative to the current directory
              and match against a file or a directory.

       named(namespace)

              The changesets in a given namespace.

              Pattern matching is supported for namespace. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       none()

              No changesets.

       obsolete()

              Mutable changeset with a newer version.

       only(set, [set])

              Changesets that are ancestors of the first set that are not ancestors of any  other  head  in  the
              repo.  If  a  second  set  is  specified,  the  result  is ancestors of the first set that are not
              ancestors of the second set (i.e. ::<set1> - ::<set2>).

       origin([set])

              Changesets that were specified as a source for the grafts, transplants or rebases that created the
              given  revisions.  Omitting the optional set is the same as passing all().  If a changeset created
              by these operations is itself specified as a source for one of these operations, only  the  source
              changeset for the first operation is selected.

       outgoing([path])

              Changesets not found in the specified destination repository, or the default push location.

       p1([set])

              First parent of changesets in set, or the working directory.

       p2([set])

              Second parent of changesets in set, or the working directory.

       parents([set])

              The set of all parents for all changesets in set, or the working directory.

       present(set)

              An empty set, if any revision in set isn't found; otherwise, all revisions in set.

              If  any  of  specified  revisions  is  not  present in the local repository, the query is normally
              aborted. But this predicate allows the query to continue even in such cases.

       public()

              Changeset in public phase.

       remote([id [,path]])

              Local revision that corresponds to the given identifier in a remote repository, if present.  Here,
              the '.' identifier is a synonym for the current local branch.

       removes(pattern)

              Changesets which remove files matching pattern.

              The  pattern  without explicit kind like glob: is expected to be relative to the current directory
              and match against a file or a directory.

       rev(number)

              Revision with the given numeric identifier.

       reverse(set)

              Reverse order of set.

       revset(set)

              Strictly interpret the content as a revset.

              The content of this special predicate will be strictly  interpreted  as  a  revset.  For  example,
              revset(id(0)) will be interpreted as "id(0)" without possible ambiguity with a "id(0)" bookmark or
              tag.

       roots(set)

              Changesets in set with no parent changeset in set.

       secret()

              Changeset in secret phase.

       sort(set[, [-]key... [, ...]])

              Sort set by keys. The default sort order is ascending, specify a key as -key to sort in descending
              order.

              The keys can be:

              • rev for the revision number,

              • branch for the branch name,

              • desc for the commit message (description),

              • user for user name (author can be used as an alias),

              • date for the commit date

              • topo for a reverse topographical sort

              The  topo  sort  order  cannot  be  combined  with  other  sort keys. This sort takes one optional
              argument, topo.firstbranch, which takes a revset that specifies  what  topographical  branches  to
              prioritize in the sort.

       subrepo([pattern])

              Changesets  that  add,  modify  or  remove the given subrepo.  If no subrepo pattern is named, any
              subrepo changes are returned.

       successors(set)

              All successors for set, including the given set themselves

       tag([name])

              The specified tag by name, or all tagged revisions if no name is given.

              Pattern matching is supported for name. See hg help revisions.patterns.

       user(string)

              User name contains string. The match is case-insensitive.

              Pattern matching is supported for string. See hg help revisions.patterns.

   Aliases
       New predicates (known as "aliases") can be defined, using any combination of existing predicates or other
       aliases. An alias definition looks like:

       <alias> = <definition>

       in  the  revsetalias  section  of  a Mercurial configuration file. Arguments of the form a1, a2, etc. are
       substituted from the alias into the definition.

       For example,

       [revsetalias]
       h = heads()
       d(s) = sort(s, date)
       rs(s, k) = reverse(sort(s, k))

       defines three aliases, h, d, and rs. rs(0:tip,  author)  is  exactly  equivalent  to  reverse(sort(0:tip,
       author)).

   Equivalents
       Command line equivalents for hg log:

       -f    ->  ::.
       -d x  ->  date(x)
       -k x  ->  keyword(x)
       -m    ->  merge()
       -u x  ->  user(x)
       -b x  ->  branch(x)
       -P x  ->  !::x
       -l x  ->  limit(expr, x)

   Examples
       Some sample queries:

       • Changesets on the default branch:

         hg log -r "branch(default)"

       • Changesets on the default branch since tag 1.5 (excluding merges):

         hg log -r "branch(default) and 1.5:: and not merge()"

       • Open branch heads:

         hg log -r "head() and not closed()"

       • Changesets between tags 1.3 and 1.5 mentioning "bug" that affect hgext/*:

         hg log -r "1.3::1.5 and keyword(bug) and file('hgext/*')"

       • Changesets committed in May 2008, sorted by user:

         hg log -r "sort(date('May 2008'), user)"

       • Changesets mentioning "bug" or "issue" that are not in a tagged release:

         hg log -r "(keyword(bug) or keyword(issue)) and not ancestors(tag())"

       • Update  to  the  commit  that  bookmark  @  is pointing to, without activating the bookmark (this works
         because the last revision of the revset is used):

         hg update :@

       • Show diff between tags 1.3 and 1.5 (this works because the first and the last revisions of  the  revset
         are used):

         hg diff -r 1.3::1.5

USING MERCURIAL FROM SCRIPTS AND AUTOMATION

       It is common for machines (as opposed to humans) to consume Mercurial.  This help topic describes some of
       the considerations for interfacing machines with Mercurial.

   Choosing an Interface
       Machines have a choice of several methods to interface with Mercurial.  These include:

       • Executing the hg process

       • Querying a HTTP server

       • Calling out to a command server

       Executing hg processes is very similar to how humans interact with Mercurial  in  the  shell.  It  should
       already be familiar to you.

       hg  serve can  be  used  to  start a server. By default, this will start a "hgweb" HTTP server. This HTTP
       server has support for machine-readable output, such as JSON. For more, see hg help hgweb.

       hg serve can also start a "command server." Clients can  connect  to  this  server  and  issue  Mercurial
       commands  over  a  special  protocol.   For more details on the command server, including links to client
       libraries, see https://www.mercurial-scm.org/wiki/CommandServer.

       hg serve based interfaces (the hgweb and command servers) have  the  advantage  over  simple  hg  process
       invocations  in  that  they  are  likely more efficient. This is because there is significant overhead to
       spawn new Python processes.

       Tip    If you need to invoke several hg processes in short order and/or performance is important to  you,
              use of a server-based interface is highly recommended.

   Environment Variables
       As documented in hg help environment, various environment variables influence the operation of Mercurial.
       The following are particularly relevant for machines consuming Mercurial:

       HGPLAIN
              If not set, Mercurial's output could be influenced  by  configuration  settings  that  impact  its
              encoding, verbose mode, localization, etc.

              It is highly recommended for machines to set this variable when invoking hg processes.

       HGENCODING
              If  not set, the locale used by Mercurial will be detected from the environment. If the determined
              locale does not support display of  certain  characters,  Mercurial  may  render  these  character
              sequences  incorrectly  (often by using "?" as a placeholder for invalid characters in the current
              locale).

              Explicitly setting this environment variable is a good practice to guarantee  consistent  results.
              "utf-8" is a good choice on UNIX-like environments.

       HGRCPATH
              If not set, Mercurial will inherit config options from config files using the process described in
              hg help config. This includes inheriting user or system-wide config files.

              When utmost control over the Mercurial configuration is desired, the value of HGRCPATH can be  set
              to  an explicit file with known good configs. In rare cases, the value can be set to an empty file
              or the null device (often /dev/null) to bypass loading of any user or system  config  files.  Note
              that  these approaches can have unintended consequences, as the user and system config files often
              define things like the  username  and  extensions  that  may  be  required  to  interface  with  a
              repository.

       HGRCSKIPREPO
              When set, the .hg/hgrc from repositories are not read.

              Note  that  not  reading  the  repository's configuration can have unintended consequences, as the
              repository config files can define things like extensions that are  required  for  access  to  the
              repository.

   Command-line Flags
       Mercurial's  default  command-line  parser  is  designed  for humans, and is not robust against malicious
       input. For instance, you can start a debugger by passing --debugger as an option value:

       $ REV=--debugger sh -c 'hg log -r "$REV"'

       This happens because several command-line flags need to be  scanned  without  using  a  concrete  command
       table, which may be modified while loading repository settings and extensions.

       Since  Mercurial 4.4.2, the parsing of such flags may be restricted by setting HGPLAIN=+strictflags. When
       this feature is enabled, all early options (e.g. -R/--repository,  --cwd,  --config)  must  be  specified
       first amongst the other global options, and cannot be injected to an arbitrary location:

       $ HGPLAIN=+strictflags hg -R "$REPO" log -r "$REV"

       In  earlier  Mercurial  versions  where  +strictflags  isn't  available,  you  can  mitigate the issue by
       concatenating an option value with its flag:

       $ hg log -r"$REV" --keyword="$KEYWORD"

   Consuming Command Output
       It is common for machines to need to parse the output of  Mercurial  commands  for  relevant  data.  This
       section describes the various techniques for doing so.

   Parsing Raw Command Output
       Likely  the  simplest  and  most  effective  solution for consuming command output is to simply invoke hg
       commands as you would as a user and parse their output.

       The output of many commands can easily be parsed with tools like grep, sed, and awk.

       A potential downside with parsing command output is that the output of commands can change when Mercurial
       is  upgraded.  While  Mercurial  does generally strive for strong backwards compatibility, command output
       does occasionally change. Having tests for your automated interactions  with  hg  commands  is  generally
       recommended, but is even more important when raw command output parsing is involved.

   Using Templates to Control Output
       Many  hg  commands  support  templatized  output  via  the  -T/--template argument. For more, see hg help
       templates.

       Templates are useful for explicitly controlling output  so  that  you  get  exactly  the  data  you  want
       formatted  how you want it. For example, log -T {node}\n can be used to print a newline delimited list of
       changeset nodes instead of a human-tailored output containing authors, dates, descriptions, etc.

       Tip    If parsing raw command output is too complicated, consider  using  templates  to  make  your  life
              easier.

       The   -T/--template   argument   allows   specifying   pre-defined  styles.   Mercurial  ships  with  the
       machine-readable styles cbor, json, and xml, which provide CBOR,  JSON,  and  XML  output,  respectively.
       These are useful for producing output that is machine readable as-is.

       (Mercurial 5.0 is required for CBOR style.)

       Important
              The  json  and  xml  styles  are  considered experimental. While they may be attractive to use for
              easily obtaining machine-readable output, their behavior may change in subsequent versions.

              These styles may also exhibit unexpected results when dealing with  certain  encodings.  Mercurial
              treats  things  like filenames as a series of bytes and normalizing certain byte sequences to JSON
              or XML with certain encoding settings can lead to surprises.

   Command Server Output
       If using the command server to interact with Mercurial, you are likely using an existing library/API that
       abstracts  implementation  details of the command server. If so, this interface layer may perform parsing
       for you, saving you the work of implementing it yourself.

   Output Verbosity
       Commands often have varying output verbosity, even when machine readable styles are being used  (e.g.  -T
       json). Adding -v/--verbose and --debug to the command's arguments can increase the amount of data exposed
       by Mercurial.

       An alternate way to get the data you need is by explicitly specifying a template.

   Other Topics
       revsets
              Revisions sets is a functional query language for selecting a set of revisions. Think of it as SQL
              for Mercurial repositories. Revsets are useful for querying repositories for specific data.

              See hg help revsets for more.

       share extension
              The  share  extension  provides  functionality  for sharing repository data across several working
              copies. It can even automatically "pool" storage for logically related repositories when cloning.

              Configuring  the  share  extension  can  lead  to  significant  resource  utilization   reduction,
              particularly around disk space and the network. This is especially true for continuous integration
              (CI) environments.

              See hg help -e share for more.

SUBREPOSITORIES

       Subrepositories let you nest external repositories or projects into a parent  Mercurial  repository,  and
       make commands operate on them as a group.

       Mercurial currently supports Mercurial, Git, and Subversion subrepositories.

       Subrepositories are made of three components:

       1. Nested repository checkouts. They can appear anywhere in the parent working directory.

       2. Nested  repository  references.  They  are  defined  in  .hgsub, which should be placed in the root of
          working directory, and tell where the subrepository checkouts come from. Mercurial subrepositories are
          referenced like:

          path/to/nested = https://example.com/nested/repo/path

          Git and Subversion subrepos are also supported:

          path/to/nested = [git]git://example.com/nested/repo/path
          path/to/nested = [svn]https://example.com/nested/trunk/path

          where  path/to/nested  is  the  checkout  location  relatively  to  the  parent  Mercurial  root,  and
          https://example.com/nested/repo/path is the source repository path. The source can  also  reference  a
          filesystem path.

          Note that .hgsub does not exist by default in Mercurial repositories, you have to create and add it to
          the parent repository before using subrepositories.

       3. Nested repository states. They are defined in .hgsubstate, which is placed  in  the  root  of  working
          directory,  and  capture  whatever information is required to restore the subrepositories to the state
          they were committed in a parent  repository  changeset.  Mercurial  automatically  record  the  nested
          repositories states when committing in the parent repository.

       Note
          The .hgsubstate file should not be edited manually.

   Adding a Subrepository
       If  .hgsub  does not exist, create it and add it to the parent repository. Clone or checkout the external
       projects where you want it to live in the parent repository. Edit .hgsub and add the subrepository  entry
       as described above. At this point, the subrepository is tracked and the next commit will record its state
       in .hgsubstate and bind it to the committed changeset.

   Synchronizing a Subrepository
       Subrepos do not automatically track the latest changeset of their sources. Instead, they are  updated  to
       the  changeset  that  corresponds  with  the changeset checked out in the top-level changeset. This is so
       developers always get a consistent set of compatible code and libraries when they update.

       Thus, updating subrepos is a manual process. Simply check out target subrepo  at  the  desired  revision,
       test in the top-level repo, then commit in the parent repository to record the new combination.

   Deleting a Subrepository
       To  remove  a subrepository from the parent repository, delete its reference from .hgsub, then remove its
       files.

   Interaction with Mercurial Commands
       add    add does not recurse in subrepos unless -S/--subrepos is specified.  However, if you  specify  the
              full  path  of  a  file  in  a  subrepo,  it  will  be added even without -S/--subrepos specified.
              Subversion subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       addremove
              addremove does not recurse into subrepos unless  -S/--subrepos  is  specified.   However,  if  you
              specify  the full path of a directory in a subrepo, addremove will be performed on it even without
              -S/--subrepos being specified.  Git and  Subversion  subrepositories  will  print  a  warning  and
              continue.

       archive
              archive does not recurse in subrepositories unless -S/--subrepos is specified.

       cat    Git  subrepositories  only  support  exact file matches.  Subversion subrepositories are currently
              ignored.

       commit commit creates a consistent snapshot of the state of the entire project and  its  subrepositories.
              If any subrepositories have been modified, Mercurial will abort.  Mercurial can be made to instead
              commit   all    modified    subrepositories    by    specifying    -S/--subrepos,    or    setting
              "ui.commitsubrepos=True"  in a configuration file (see hg help config).  After there are no longer
              any modified subrepositories, it records  their  state  and  finally  commits  it  in  the  parent
              repository.   The  --addremove  option  also  honors  the  -S/--subrepos option.  However, Git and
              Subversion subrepositories will print a warning and abort.

       diff   diff does not recurse in subrepos unless -S/--subrepos is specified.  However, if you specify  the
              full  path of a file or directory in a subrepo, it will be diffed even without -S/--subrepos being
              specified.  Subversion subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       files  files does not recurse into subrepos unless -S/--subrepos is specified.  However, if  you  specify
              the full path of a file or directory in a subrepo, it will be displayed even without -S/--subrepos
              being specified.  Git and Subversion subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       forget forget currently only handles exact file matches in subrepos.  Git and Subversion  subrepositories
              are currently silently ignored.

       incoming
              incoming  does  not  recurse  in  subrepos  unless  -S/--subrepos is specified. Git and Subversion
              subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       outgoing
              outgoing does not recurse in subrepos  unless  -S/--subrepos  is  specified.  Git  and  Subversion
              subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       pull   pull  is  not recursive since it is not clear what to pull prior to running hg update. Listing and
              retrieving all subrepositories changes referenced by the parent repository  pulled  changesets  is
              expensive at best, impossible in the Subversion case.

       push   Mercurial  will  automatically  push all subrepositories first when the parent repository is being
              pushed. This ensures  new  subrepository  changes  are  available  when  referenced  by  top-level
              repositories.  Push is a no-op for Subversion subrepositories.

       serve  serve does not recurse into subrepositories unless -S/--subrepos is specified.  Git and Subversion
              subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       status status does not recurse into subrepositories  unless  -S/--subrepos  is  specified.  Subrepository
              changes  are  displayed  as  regular  Mercurial  changes on the subrepository elements. Subversion
              subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       remove remove does not recurse into subrepositories unless -S/--subrepos is specified.  However,  if  you
              specify a file or directory path in a subrepo, it will be removed even without -S/--subrepos.  Git
              and Subversion subrepositories are currently silently ignored.

       update update restores the subrepos in the state they were originally committed in target  changeset.  If
              the  recorded  changeset  is not available in the current subrepository, Mercurial will pull it in
              first  before  updating.   This  means  that  updating  can  require  network  access  when  using
              subrepositories.

   Remapping Subrepositories Sources
       A  subrepository  source location may change during a project life, invalidating references stored in the
       parent repository history. To fix this, rewriting rules can be defined in parent repository hgrc file  or
       in Mercurial configuration. See the [subpaths] section in hgrc(5) for more details.

TEMPLATE USAGE

       Mercurial allows you to customize output of commands through templates. You can either pass in a template
       or select an existing template-style from the command line, via the --template option.

       You can customize output for any "log-like" command: log, outgoing, incoming, tip, parents, and heads.

       Some built-in styles are packaged with Mercurial. These can  be  listed  with  hg  log  --template  list.
       Example usage:

       $ hg log -r1.0::1.1 --template changelog

       A template is a piece of text, with markup to invoke variable expansion:

       $ hg log -r1 --template "{node}\n"
       b56ce7b07c52de7d5fd79fb89701ea538af65746

   Keywords
       Strings in curly braces are called keywords. The availability of keywords depends on the exact context of
       the templater. These keywords are usually available for templating a log-like command:

       activebookmark
              String. The active bookmark, if it is associated with the changeset.

       author Alias for {user}

       bisect String. The changeset bisection status.

       bookmarks
              List of strings. Any bookmarks associated with the changeset. Also sets 'active', the name of  the
              active bookmark.

       branch String. The name of the branch on which the changeset was committed.

       changessincelatesttag
              Integer. All ancestors not in the latest tag.

       children
              List of strings. The children of the changeset.

       date   Date information. The date when the changeset was committed.

       desc   String. The text of the changeset description.

       diffstat
              String. Statistics of changes with the following format: "modified files: +added/-removed lines"

       extras List of dicts with key, value entries of the 'extras' field of this changeset.

       file_adds
              List of strings. Files added by this changeset.

       file_copies
              List of strings. Files copied in this changeset with their sources.

       file_copies_switch
              List of strings. Like "file_copies" but displayed only if the --copied switch is set.

       file_dels
              List of strings. Files removed by this changeset.

       file_mods
              List of strings. Files modified by this changeset.

       files  List of strings. All files modified, added, or removed by this changeset.

       graphnode
              String. The character representing the changeset node in an ASCII revision graph.

       graphwidth
              Integer. The width of the graph drawn by 'log --graph' or zero.

       index  Integer. The current iteration of the loop. (0 indexed)

       latesttag
              List  of  strings.  The global tags on the most recent globally tagged ancestor of this changeset.
              If no such tags exist, the list consists of the single string "null".

       latesttagdistance
              Integer. Longest path to the latest tag.

       namespaces
              Dict of lists. Names attached to this changeset per namespace.

       negrev Integer. The repository-local changeset negative revision number, which  counts  in  the  opposite
              direction.

       node   String. The changeset identification hash, as a 40 hexadecimal digit string.

       p1     Changeset.  The  changeset's first parent. {p1.rev} for the revision number, and {p1.node} for the
              identification hash.

       p2     Changeset. The changeset's second parent. {p2.rev} for the revision number, and {p2.node} for  the
              identification hash.

       parents
              List  of strings. The parents of the changeset in "rev:node" format. If the changeset has only one
              "natural" parent (the predecessor revision) nothing is shown.

       peerurls
              A dictionary of repository locations defined in the [paths] section of your configuration file.

       phase  String. The changeset phase name.

       reporoot
              String. The root directory of the current repository.

       rev    Integer. The repository-local changeset revision number.

       subrepos
              List of strings. Updated subrepositories in the changeset.

       tags   List of strings. Any tags associated with the changeset.

       termwidth
              Integer. The width of the current terminal.

       user   String. The unmodified author of the changeset.

       verbosity
              String. The current output verbosity in 'debug', 'quiet', 'verbose', or ''.

       The "date" keyword does not produce human-readable output. If you want to use a date in your output,  you
       can  use a filter to process it. Filters are functions which return a string based on the input variable.
       Be sure to use the stringify filter first when you're applying a string-input filter to a list-like input
       variable.  You can also use a chain of filters to get the desired output:

       $ hg tip --template "{date|isodate}\n"
       2008-08-21 18:22 +0000

   Filters
       List of filters:

       addbreaks
              Any text. Add an XHTML "<br />" tag before the end of every line except the last.

       age    Date.  Returns  a  human-readable date/time difference between the given date/time and the current
              date/time.

       basename
              Any text. Treats the text as a path, and returns the last component of the path after splitting by
              the path separator.  For example, "foo/bar/baz" becomes "baz" and "foo/bar//" becomes "".

       cbor   Any object. Serializes the object to CBOR bytes.

       commondir
              List  of text. Treats each list item as file name with / as path separator and returns the longest
              common directory prefix shared by all list items.  Returns the empty string if  no  common  prefix
              exists.

              The  list  items  are  not normalized, i.e. "foo/../bar" is handled as file "bar" in the directory
              "foo/..". Leading slashes are ignored.

              For example, ["foo/bar/baz", "foo/baz/bar"] becomes "foo" and ["foo/bar", "baz"] becomes "".

       count  List or text. Returns the length as an integer.

       dirname
              Any text. Treats the text as a path, and strips the last component of the path after splitting  by
              the path separator.

       domain Any  text.  Finds  the first string that looks like an email address, and extracts just the domain
              component. Example: User <user@example.com> becomes example.com.

       email  Any  text.  Extracts  the  first  string  that  looks  like  an  email  address.   Example:   User
              <user@example.com> becomes user@example.com.

       emailuser
              Any text. Returns the user portion of an email address.

       escape Any  text.  Replaces  the  special  XML/XHTML  characters  "&", "<" and ">" with XML entities, and
              filters out NUL characters.

       fill68 Any text. Wraps the text to fit in 68 columns.

       fill76 Any text. Wraps the text to fit in 76 columns.

       firstline
              Any text. Returns the first line of text.

       hex    Any text. Convert a binary Mercurial node identifier into its long hexadecimal representation.

       hgdate Date. Returns the date as a pair of numbers: "1157407993 25200" (Unix timestamp, timezone offset).

       isodate
              Date. Returns the date in ISO 8601 format: "2009-08-18 13:00 +0200".

       isodatesec
              Date. Returns the date in ISO 8601 format, including seconds:  "2009-08-18  13:00:13  +0200".  See
              also the rfc3339date filter.

       json   Any object. Serializes the object to a JSON formatted text.

       lower  Any text. Converts the text to lowercase.

       nonempty
              Any text. Returns '(none)' if the string is empty.

       obfuscate
              Any text. Returns the input text rendered as a sequence of XML entities.

       person Any text. Returns the name before an email address, interpreting it as per RFC 5322.

       revescape
              Any  text.  Escapes  all  "special"  characters,  except  @.  Forward slashes are escaped twice to
              prevent web servers  from  prematurely  unescaping  them.  For  example,  "@foo  bar/baz"  becomes
              "@foo%20bar%252Fbaz".

       rfc3339date
              Date.   Returns   a   date   using   the   Internet   date   format   specified   in   RFC   3339:
              "2009-08-18T13:00:13+02:00".

       rfc822date
              Date. Returns a date using the same format used in email  headers:  "Tue,  18  Aug  2009  13:00:13
              +0200".

       short  Changeset hash. Returns the short form of a changeset hash, i.e. a 12 hexadecimal digit string.

       shortbisect
              Any  text.  Treats  label  as  a bisection status, and returns a single-character representing the
              status (G: good, B: bad, S: skipped, U: untested, I: ignored). Returns single space if text is not
              a valid bisection status.

       shortdate
              Date. Returns a date like "2006-09-18".

       slashpath
              Any text. Replaces the native path separator with slash.

       splitlines
              Any text. Split text into a list of lines.

       stringify
              Any type. Turns the value into text by converting values into text and concatenating them.

       stripdir
              Treat  the text as path and strip a directory level, if possible. For example, "foo" and "foo/bar"
              becomes "foo".

       tabindent
              Any text. Returns the text, with every non-empty  line  except  the  first  starting  with  a  tab
              character.

       upper  Any text. Converts the text to uppercase.

       urlescape
              Any text. Escapes all "special" characters. For example, "foo bar" becomes "foo%20bar".

       user   Any text. Returns a short representation of a user name or email address.

       utf8   Any text. Converts from the local character encoding to UTF-8.

       Note that a filter is nothing more than a function call, i.e.  expr|filter is equivalent to filter(expr).

   Functions
       In addition to filters, there are some basic built-in functions:

       config(section, name[, default])
              Returns the requested hgrc config option as a string.

       configbool(section, name[, default])
              Returns the requested hgrc config option as a boolean.

       configint(section, name[, default])
              Returns the requested hgrc config option as an integer.

       date(date[, fmt])
              Format  a  date.  See  hg  help  dates for  formatting strings. The default is a Unix date format,
              including the timezone: "Mon Sep 04 15:13:13 2006 0700".

       dict([[key=]value...])
              Construct a dict from key-value pairs. A key may be omitted if a value expression can  provide  an
              unambiguous name.

       diff([includepattern [, excludepattern]])
              Show a diff, optionally specifying files to include or exclude.

       files(pattern)
              All files of the current changeset matching the pattern. See hg help patterns.

       fill(text[, width[, initialident[, hangindent]]])
              Fill many paragraphs with optional indentation. See the "fill" filter.

       filter(iterable[, expr])
              Remove  empty  elements  from a list or a dict. If expr specified, it's applied to each element to
              test emptiness.

       get(dict, key)
              Get an attribute/key from an object. Some keywords are complex types. This function allows you  to
              obtain the value of an attribute on these types.

       if(expr, then[, else])
              Conditionally execute based on the result of an expression.

       ifcontains(needle, haystack, then[, else])
              Conditionally execute based on whether the item "needle" is in "haystack".

       ifeq(expr1, expr2, then[, else])
              Conditionally execute based on whether 2 items are equivalent.

       indent(text, indentchars[, firstline])
              Indents all non-empty lines with the characters given in the indentchars string. An optional third
              parameter will override the indent for the first line only if present.

       join(list, sep)
              Join items in a list with a delimiter.

       label(label, expr)
              Apply a label to generated content.  Content  with  a  label  applied  can  result  in  additional
              post-processing, such as automatic colorization.

       latesttag([pattern])
              The  global  tags  matching  the given pattern on the most recent globally tagged ancestor of this
              changeset.  If no such tags exist, the "{tag}" template resolves to the string "null". See hg help
              revisions.patterns for the pattern syntax.

       localdate(date[, tz])
              Converts a date to the specified timezone.  The default is local date.

       mailmap(author)
              Return the author, updated according to the value set in the .mailmap file

       max(iterable)
              Return the max of an iterable

       min(iterable)
              Return the min of an iterable

       mod(a, b)
              Calculate a mod b such that a / b + a mod b == a

       pad(text, width[, fillchar=' '[, left=False[, truncate=False]]])
              Pad text with a fill character.

       relpath(path)
              Convert  a  repository-absolute  path  into  a  filesystem  path  relative  to the current working
              directory.

       revset(query[, formatargs...])
              Execute a revision set query. See hg help revset.

       rstdoc(text, style)
              Format reStructuredText.

       search(pattern, text)
              Look for the first text matching the regular expression pattern.  Groups are  accessible  as  {1},
              {2}, ... in %-mapped template.

       separate(sep, args...)
              Add a separator between non-empty arguments.

       shortest(node, minlength=4)
              Obtain the shortest representation of a node.

       startswith(pattern, text)
              Returns  the  value  from  the  "text"  argument  if it begins with the content from the "pattern"
              argument.

       strip(text[, chars])
              Strip characters from a string. By default, strips all leading and trailing whitespace.

       sub(pattern, replacement, expression)
              Perform text substitution using regular expressions.

       word(number, text[, separator])
              Return the nth word from a string.

   Operators
       We provide a limited set of infix arithmetic operations on integers:

       + for addition
       - for subtraction
       * for multiplication
       / for floor division (division rounded to integer nearest -infinity)

       Division fulfills the law x = x / y + mod(x, y).

       Also, for any expression that returns a list, there is a list operator:

       expr % "{template}"

       As seen in the above example, {template} is  interpreted  as  a  template.   To  prevent  it  from  being
       interpreted, you can use an escape character \{ or a raw string prefix, r'...'.

       The dot operator can be used as a shorthand for accessing a sub item:

       • expr.member  is  roughly  equivalent to expr % '{member}' if expr returns a non-list/dict. The returned
         value is not stringified.

       • dict.key is identical to get(dict, 'key').

   Aliases
       New keywords and functions can be defined in the templatealias section of a Mercurial configuration file:

       <alias> = <definition>

       Arguments of the form a1, a2, etc. are substituted from the alias into the definition.

       For example,

       [templatealias]
       r = rev
       rn = "{r}:{node|short}"
       leftpad(s, w) = pad(s, w, ' ', True)

       defines two symbol aliases, r and rn, and a function alias leftpad().

       It's also possible to specify complete template strings, using the templates section. The syntax used  is
       the general template string syntax.

       For example,

       [templates]
       nodedate = "{node|short}: {date(date, "%Y-%m-%d")}\n"

       defines a template, nodedate, which can be called like:

       $ hg log -r . -Tnodedate

       A template defined in templates section can also be referenced from another template:

       $ hg log -r . -T "{rev} {nodedate}"

       but  be  aware  that  the  keywords cannot be overridden by templates. For example, a template defined as
       templates.rev cannot be referenced as {rev}.

       A template defined in templates section may have sub templates which  are  inserted  before/after/between
       items:

       [templates]
       myjson = ' {dict(rev, node|short)|json}'
       myjson:docheader = '\{\n'
       myjson:docfooter = '\n}\n'
       myjson:separator = ',\n'

   Examples
       Some sample command line templates:

       • Format lists, e.g. files:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "files:\n{files % '  {file}\n'}"

       • Join the list of files with a ", ":

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "files: {join(files, ', ')}\n"

       • Join the list of files ending with ".py" with a ", ":

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "pythonfiles: {join(files('**.py'), ', ')}\n"

       • Separate non-empty arguments by a " ":

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{separate(' ', node, bookmarks, tags}\n"

       • Modify each line of a commit description:

         $ hg log --template "{splitlines(desc) % '**** {line}\n'}"

       • Format date:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{date(date, '%Y')}\n"

       • Display date in UTC:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{localdate(date, 'UTC')|date}\n"

       • Output the description set to a fill-width of 30:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{fill(desc, 30)}"

       • Use a conditional to test for the default branch:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{ifeq(branch, 'default', 'on the main branch',
         'on branch {branch}')}\n"

       • Append a newline if not empty:

         $ hg tip --template "{if(author, '{author}\n')}"

       • Label the output for use with the color extension:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{label('changeset.{phase}', node|short)}\n"

       • Invert the firstline filter, i.e. everything but the first line:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{sub(r'^.*\n?\n?', '', desc)}\n"

       • Display the contents of the 'extra' field, one per line:

         $ hg log -r 0 --template "{join(extras, '\n')}\n"

       • Mark the active bookmark with '*':

         $ hg log --template "{bookmarks % '{bookmark}{ifeq(bookmark, active, '*')} '}\n"

       • Find the previous release candidate tag, the distance and changes since the tag:

         $ hg log -r . --template "{latesttag('re:^.*-rc$') % '{tag}, {changes}, {distance}'}\n"

       • Mark the working copy parent with '@':

         $ hg log --template "{ifcontains(rev, revset('.'), '@')}\n"

       • Show details of parent revisions:

         $ hg log --template "{revset('parents(%d)', rev) % '{desc|firstline}\n'}"

       • Show only commit descriptions that start with "template":

         $ hg log --template "{startswith('template', firstline(desc))}\n"

       • Print the first word of each line of a commit message:

         $ hg log --template "{word(0, desc)}\n"

URL PATHS

       Valid URLs are of the form:

       local/filesystem/path[#revision]
       file://local/filesystem/path[#revision]
       http://[user[:pass]@]host[:port]/[path][#revision]
       https://[user[:pass]@]host[:port]/[path][#revision]
       ssh://[user@]host[:port]/[path][#revision]

       Paths  in  the local filesystem can either point to Mercurial repositories or to bundle files (as created
       by hg bundle or hg incoming --bundle). See also hg help paths.

       An optional identifier after # indicates a particular branch, tag, or changeset to use  from  the  remote
       repository. See also hg help revisions.

       Some  features,  such  as  pushing  to  http:// and  https:// URLs  are  only  possible if the feature is
       explicitly enabled on the remote Mercurial server.

       Note that the security of HTTPS URLs depends on proper configuration of web.cacerts.

       Some notes about using SSH with Mercurial:

       • SSH requires an accessible shell account on the destination machine and a copy of hg in the remote path
         or specified with remotecmd.

       • path  is  relative to the remote user's home directory by default. Use an extra slash at the start of a
         path to specify an absolute path:

         ssh://example.com//tmp/repository

       • Mercurial doesn't use its own compression via SSH; the right thing to do is to  configure  it  in  your
         ~/.ssh/config, e.g.:

         Host *.mylocalnetwork.example.com
           Compression no
         Host *
           Compression yes

         Alternatively specify "ssh -C" as your ssh command in your configuration file or with the --ssh command
         line option.

       These URLs can all be stored in your configuration file with path aliases under the [paths] section  like
       so:

       [paths]
       alias1 = URL1
       alias2 = URL2
       ...

       You can then use the alias for any command that uses a URL (for example hg pull alias1 will be treated as
       hg pull URL1).

       Two path aliases are special because they are used as defaults when you do  not  provide  the  URL  to  a
       command:

       default:
              When  you  create  a  repository with hg clone, the clone command saves the location of the source
              repository as the new repository's 'default' path. This is then used when you omit path from push-
              and pull-like commands (including incoming and outgoing).

       default-push:
              The  push  command will look for a path named 'default-push', and prefer it over 'default' if both
              are defined.

EXTENSIONS

       This section contains help for extensions that are distributed together with Mercurial.  Help  for  other
       extensions is available in the help system.

   absorb
       apply working directory changes to changesets (EXPERIMENTAL)

       The  absorb  extension  provides  a command to use annotate information to amend modified chunks into the
       corresponding non-public changesets.

       [absorb]
       # only check 50 recent non-public changesets at most
       max-stack-size = 50
       # whether to add noise to new commits to avoid obsolescence cycle
       add-noise = 1
       # make `amend --correlated` a shortcut to the main command
       amend-flag = correlated

       [color]
       absorb.description = yellow
       absorb.node = blue bold
       absorb.path = bold

   Commands
   Change creation
   absorb
       incorporate corrections into the stack of draft changesets:

       hg absorb [OPTION] [FILE]...

       absorb analyzes each change in your working directory and attempts to amend the changed  lines  into  the
       changesets in your stack that first introduced those lines.

       If  absorb  cannot  find  an unambiguous changeset to amend for a change, that change will be left in the
       working directory, untouched. They can be observed by hg status or hg diff afterwards.  In  other  words,
       absorb does not write to the working directory.

       Changesets outside the revset ::. and not public() and not merge() will not be changed.

       Changesets that become empty after applying the changes will be deleted.

       By  default, absorb will show what it plans to do and prompt for confirmation.  If you are confident that
       the changes will be absorbed to the correct place, run hg absorb -a to apply the changes immediately.

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if all chunks were ignored and nothing amended.

       Options:

       -a, --apply-changes
              apply changes without prompting for confirmation

       -p, --print-changes
              always print which changesets are modified by which changes

       -i, --interactive
              interactively select which chunks to apply (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -e, --edit-lines
              edit what lines belong to which changesets before commit (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   acl
       hooks for controlling repository access

       This hook makes it possible to allow or deny write access to given branches and  paths  of  a  repository
       when receiving incoming changesets via pretxnchangegroup and pretxncommit.

       The  authorization is matched based on the local user name on the system where the hook runs, and not the
       committer of the original changeset (since the latter is merely informative).

       The acl hook is best used along with a restricted shell like hgsh, preventing authenticating  users  from
       doing anything other than pushing or pulling. The hook is not safe to use if users have interactive shell
       access, as they can then disable the hook. Nor is it safe if remote users share an account, because  then
       there is no way to distinguish them.

       The order in which access checks are performed is:

       1. Deny  list for branches (section acl.deny.branches)

       2. Allow list for branches (section acl.allow.branches)

       3. Deny  list for paths    (section acl.deny)

       4. Allow list for paths    (section acl.allow)

       The allow and deny sections take key-value pairs.

   Branch-based Access Control
       Use  the  acl.deny.branches  and acl.allow.branches sections to have branch-based access control. Keys in
       these sections can be either:

       • a branch name, or

       • an asterisk, to match any branch;

       The corresponding values can be either:

       • a comma-separated list containing users and groups, or

       • an asterisk, to match anyone;

       You can add the "!" prefix to a user or group name to invert the sense of the match.

   Path-based Access Control
       Use the acl.deny and acl.allow sections to have path-based access control. Keys in these sections  accept
       a subtree pattern (with a glob syntax by default). The corresponding values follow the same syntax as the
       other sections above.

   Bookmark-based Access Control
       Use the acl.deny.bookmarks and acl.allow.bookmarks sections to have bookmark-based access  control.  Keys
       in these sections can be either:

       • a bookmark name, or

       • an asterisk, to match any bookmark;

       The corresponding values can be either:

       • a comma-separated list containing users and groups, or

       • an asterisk, to match anyone;

       You can add the "!" prefix to a user or group name to invert the sense of the match.

       Note: for interactions between clients and servers using Mercurial 3.6+ a rejection will generally reject
       the entire push, for interactions involving older  clients,  the  commit  transactions  will  already  be
       accepted, and only the bookmark movement will be rejected.

   Groups
       Group  names must be prefixed with an @ symbol. Specifying a group name has the same effect as specifying
       all the users in that group.

       You can define group members in the acl.groups section.  If a  group  name  is  not  defined  there,  and
       Mercurial  is  running under a Unix-like system, the list of users will be taken from the OS.  Otherwise,
       an exception will be raised.

   Example Configuration
       [hooks]

       # Use this if you want to check access restrictions at commit time
       pretxncommit.acl = python:hgext.acl.hook

       # Use this if you want to check access restrictions for pull, push,
       # bundle and serve.
       pretxnchangegroup.acl = python:hgext.acl.hook

       [acl]
       # Allow or deny access for incoming changes only if their source is
       # listed here, let them pass otherwise. Source is "serve" for all
       # remote access (http or ssh), "push", "pull" or "bundle" when the
       # related commands are run locally.
       # Default: serve
       sources = serve

       [acl.deny.branches]

       # Everyone is denied to the frozen branch:
       frozen-branch = *

       # A bad user is denied on all branches:
       * = bad-user

       [acl.allow.branches]

       # A few users are allowed on branch-a:
       branch-a = user-1, user-2, user-3

       # Only one user is allowed on branch-b:
       branch-b = user-1

       # The super user is allowed on any branch:
       * = super-user

       # Everyone is allowed on branch-for-tests:
       branch-for-tests = *

       [acl.deny]
       # This list is checked first. If a match is found, acl.allow is not
       # checked. All users are granted access if acl.deny is not present.
       # Format for both lists: glob pattern = user, ..., @group, ...

       # To match everyone, use an asterisk for the user:
       # my/glob/pattern = *

       # user6 will not have write access to any file:
       ** = user6

       # Group "hg-denied" will not have write access to any file:
       ** = @hg-denied

       # Nobody will be able to change "DONT-TOUCH-THIS.txt", despite
       # everyone being able to change all other files. See below.
       src/main/resources/DONT-TOUCH-THIS.txt = *

       [acl.allow]
       # if acl.allow is not present, all users are allowed by default
       # empty acl.allow = no users allowed

       # User "doc_writer" has write access to any file under the "docs"
       # folder:
       docs/** = doc_writer

       # User "jack" and group "designers" have write access to any file
       # under the "images" folder:
       images/** = jack, @designers

       # Everyone (except for "user6" and "@hg-denied" - see acl.deny above)
       # will have write access to any file under the "resources" folder
       # (except for 1 file. See acl.deny):
       src/main/resources/** = *

       .hgtags = release_engineer

   Examples using the ! prefix
       Suppose there's a branch that only a given user (or group) should be able to push to, and you don't  want
       to restrict access to any other branch that may be created.

       The  "!"  prefix  allows you to prevent anyone except a given user or group to push changesets in a given
       branch or path.

       In the examples below, we will: 1) Deny access to branch "ring" to  anyone  but  user  "gollum"  2)  Deny
       access  to  branch  "lake" to anyone but members of the group "hobbit" 3) Deny access to a file to anyone
       but user "gollum"

       [acl.allow.branches]
       # Empty

       [acl.deny.branches]

       # 1) only 'gollum' can commit to branch 'ring';
       # 'gollum' and anyone else can still commit to any other branch.
       ring = !gollum

       # 2) only members of the group 'hobbit' can commit to branch 'lake';
       # 'hobbit' members and anyone else can still commit to any other branch.
       lake = !@hobbit

       # You can also deny access based on file paths:

       [acl.allow]
       # Empty

       [acl.deny]
       # 3) only 'gollum' can change the file below;
       # 'gollum' and anyone else can still change any other file.
       /misty/mountains/cave/ring = !gollum

   amend
       provide the amend command (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension provides an amend command that is similar to commit --amend but does not prompt an editor.

   Commands
   Change creation
   amend
       amend the working copy parent with all or specified outstanding changes:

       hg amend [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Similar to hg commit --amend, but reuse the commit message without invoking  editor,  unless  --edit  was
       set.

       See hg help commit for more details.

       Options:

       -A, --addremove
              mark new/missing files as added/removed before committing

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -i, --interactive
              use interactive mode

       --close-branch
              mark a branch as closed, hiding it from the branch list

       -s, --secret
              use the secret phase for committing

       -n,--note <VALUE>
              store a note on the amend

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -D, --currentdate
              record the current date as commit date

       -U, --currentuser
              record the current user as committer

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   automv
       check for unrecorded moves at commit time (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension checks at commit/amend time if any of the committed files comes from an unrecorded mv.

       The  threshold  at which a file is considered a move can be set with the automv.similarity config option.
       This option takes a percentage between 0 (disabled) and 100 (files must be identical), the default is 95.

   beautifygraph
       beautify log -G output by using Unicode characters (EXPERIMENTAL)

          A terminal with UTF-8 support and monospace narrow text are required.

   blackbox
       log repository events to a blackbox for debugging

       Logs event information to .hg/blackbox.log to help debug and diagnose  problems.   The  events  that  get
       logged can be configured via the blackbox.track and blackbox.ignore config keys.

       Examples:

       [blackbox]
       track = *
       ignore = pythonhook
       # dirty is *EXPENSIVE* (slow);
       # each log entry indicates `+` if the repository is dirty, like :hg:`id`.
       dirty = True
       # record the source of log messages
       logsource = True

       [blackbox]
       track = command, commandfinish, commandexception, exthook, pythonhook

       [blackbox]
       track = incoming

       [blackbox]
       # limit the size of a log file
       maxsize = 1.5 MB
       # rotate up to N log files when the current one gets too big
       maxfiles = 3

       [blackbox]
       # Include nanoseconds in log entries with %f (see Python function
       # datetime.datetime.strftime)
       date-format = '%Y-%m-%d @ %H:%M:%S.%f'

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   blackbox
       view the recent repository events:

       hg blackbox [OPTION]...

       view the recent repository events

       Options:

       -l,--limit <VALUE>
              the number of events to show (default: 10)

   bookflow
       implements bookmark-based branching (EXPERIMENTAL)

          • Disables creation of new branches (config: enable_branches=False).

          • Requires an active bookmark on commit (config: require_bookmark=True).

          • Doesn't move the active bookmark on update, only on commit.

          • Requires '--rev' for moving an existing bookmark.

          • Protects special bookmarks (config: protect=@).

          flow related commands

              hg book NAME
                     create a new bookmark

              hg book NAME -r REV
                     move bookmark to revision (fast-forward)

              hg up|co NAME
                     switch to bookmark

              hg push -B .
                     push active bookmark

   bugzilla
       hooks for integrating with the Bugzilla bug tracker

       This  hook  extension adds comments on bugs in Bugzilla when changesets that refer to bugs by Bugzilla ID
       are seen. The comment is formatted using the Mercurial template mechanism.

       The bug references can optionally include an update for Bugzilla of the hours spent working on  the  bug.
       Bugs can also be marked fixed.

       Four basic modes of access to Bugzilla are provided:

       1. Access via the Bugzilla REST-API. Requires bugzilla 5.0 or later.

       2. Access via the Bugzilla XMLRPC interface. Requires Bugzilla 3.4 or later.

       3. Check  data  via  the  Bugzilla  XMLRPC  interface  and  submit bug change via email to Bugzilla email
          interface. Requires Bugzilla 3.4 or later.

       4. Writing directly to the Bugzilla database. Only Bugzilla  installations  using  MySQL  are  supported.
          Requires Python MySQLdb.

       Writing  directly  to  the  database  is  susceptible to schema changes, and relies on a Bugzilla contrib
       script to send out bug change notification emails. This script runs as the user running  Mercurial,  must
       be  run  on  the  host  with the Bugzilla install, and requires permission to read Bugzilla configuration
       details and the necessary MySQL user and password to have full access rights to  the  Bugzilla  database.
       For these reasons this access mode is now considered deprecated, and will not be updated for new Bugzilla
       versions going forward. Only adding comments is supported in this access mode.

       Access via XMLRPC needs a Bugzilla username and password to be specified in the  configuration.  Comments
       are  added  under  that  username. Since the configuration must be readable by all Mercurial users, it is
       recommended that the rights of that user are restricted in Bugzilla  to  the  minimum  necessary  to  add
       comments. Marking bugs fixed requires Bugzilla 4.0 and later.

       Access via XMLRPC/email uses XMLRPC to query Bugzilla, but sends email to the Bugzilla email interface to
       submit comments to bugs.  The From: address in the email is set to the email  address  of  the  Mercurial
       user,  so the comment appears to come from the Mercurial user. In the event that the Mercurial user email
       is not recognized by Bugzilla as a Bugzilla user, the email associated with the Bugzilla username used to
       log into Bugzilla is used instead as the source of the comment. Marking bugs fixed works on all supported
       Bugzilla versions.

       Access via the REST-API needs either a Bugzilla username and password  or  an  apikey  specified  in  the
       configuration.  Comments  are  made  under  the  given username or the user associated with the apikey in
       Bugzilla.

       Configuration items common to all access modes:

       bugzilla.version
              The access type to use. Values recognized are:

              restapi

                     Bugzilla REST-API, Bugzilla 5.0 and later.

              xmlrpc

                     Bugzilla XMLRPC interface.

              xmlrpc+email

                     Bugzilla XMLRPC and email interfaces.

              3.0

                     MySQL access, Bugzilla 3.0 and later.

              2.18

                     MySQL access, Bugzilla 2.18 and up to but not including 3.0.

              2.16

                     MySQL access, Bugzilla 2.16 and up to but not including 2.18.

       bugzilla.regexp
              Regular expression to match bug IDs for update in changeset commit message.  It must  contain  one
              "()"  named  group  <ids>  containing  the  bug IDs separated by non-digit characters. It may also
              contain a named group <hours> with a floating-point number giving the hours worked on the bug.  If
              no named groups are present, the first "()" group is assumed to contain the bug IDs, and work time
              is not updated. The default expression matches Bug 1234, Bug  no.  1234,  Bug  number  1234,  Bugs
              1234,5678,  Bug 1234 and 5678 and variations thereof, followed by an hours number prefixed by h or
              hours, e.g. hours 1.5. Matching is case insensitive.

       bugzilla.fixregexp
              Regular expression to match bug IDs for marking fixed  in  changeset  commit  message.  This  must
              contain a "()" named group <ids>` containing the bug IDs separated by non-digit characters. It may
              also contain a named group ``<hours> with a floating-point number giving the hours worked  on  the
              bug.  If  no named groups are present, the first "()" group is assumed to contain the bug IDs, and
              work time is not updated. The default expression matches Fixes 1234, Fixes bug  1234,  Fixes  bugs
              1234,5678,  Fixes  1234 and 5678 and variations thereof, followed by an hours number prefixed by h
              or hours, e.g. hours 1.5. Matching is case insensitive.

       bugzilla.fixstatus
              The status to set a bug to when marking fixed. Default RESOLVED.

       bugzilla.fixresolution
              The resolution to set a bug to when marking fixed. Default FIXED.

       bugzilla.style
              The style file to use when formatting comments.

       bugzilla.template
              Template to use when formatting comments. Overrides style if specified. In addition to  the  usual
              Mercurial keywords, the extension specifies:

              {bug}

                     The Bugzilla bug ID.

              {root}

                     The full pathname of the Mercurial repository.

              {webroot}

                     Stripped pathname of the Mercurial repository.

              {hgweb}

                     Base URL for browsing Mercurial repositories.

              Default changeset {node|short} in repo {root} refers to bug {bug}.\ndetails:\n\t{desc|tabindent}

       bugzilla.strip
              The  number  of path separator characters to strip from the front of the Mercurial repository path
              ({root}  in  templates)  to  produce  {webroot}.   For   example,   a   repository   with   {root}
              /var/local/my-project with a strip of 2 gives a value for {webroot} of my-project. Default 0.

       web.baseurl
              Base URL for browsing Mercurial repositories. Referenced from templates as {hgweb}.

       Configuration items common to XMLRPC+email and MySQL access modes:

       bugzilla.usermap
              Path  of  file containing Mercurial committer email to Bugzilla user email mappings. If specified,
              the file should contain one mapping per line:

              committer = Bugzilla user

              See also the [usermap] section.

       The [usermap] section is used to specify mappings of Mercurial committer email to  Bugzilla  user  email.
       See also bugzilla.usermap.  Contains entries of the form committer = Bugzilla user.

       XMLRPC and REST-API access mode configuration:

       bugzilla.bzurl
              The base URL for the Bugzilla installation.  Default http://localhost/bugzilla.

       bugzilla.user
              The username to use to log into Bugzilla via XMLRPC. Default bugs.

       bugzilla.password
              The password for Bugzilla login.

       REST-API access mode uses the options listed above as well as:

       bugzilla.apikey
              An  apikey generated on the Bugzilla instance for api access.  Using an apikey removes the need to
              store the user and password options.

       XMLRPC+email access mode uses the XMLRPC access mode configuration items, and also:

       bugzilla.bzemail
              The Bugzilla email address.

       In addition, the Mercurial email settings must be configured. See the documentation in hgrc(5),  sections
       [email] and [smtp].

       MySQL access mode configuration:

       bugzilla.host
              Hostname of the MySQL server holding the Bugzilla database.  Default localhost.

       bugzilla.db
              Name of the Bugzilla database in MySQL. Default bugs.

       bugzilla.user
              Username to use to access MySQL server. Default bugs.

       bugzilla.password
              Password to use to access MySQL server.

       bugzilla.timeout
              Database connection timeout (seconds). Default 5.

       bugzilla.bzuser
              Fallback  Bugzilla  user name to record comments with, if changeset committer cannot be found as a
              Bugzilla user.

       bugzilla.bzdir
              Bugzilla install directory. Used by default notify. Default /var/www/html/bugzilla.

       bugzilla.notify
              The command to run to get Bugzilla to send bug change notification emails. Substitutes from a  map
              with  3  keys, bzdir, id (bug id) and user (committer bugzilla email). Default depends on version;
              from 2.18 it is "cd %(bzdir)s && perl -T contrib/sendbugmail.pl %(id)s %(user)s".

       Activating the extension:

       [extensions]
       bugzilla =

       [hooks]
       # run bugzilla hook on every change pulled or pushed in here
       incoming.bugzilla = python:hgext.bugzilla.hook

       Example configurations:

       XMLRPC example configuration. This uses the Bugzilla at  http://my-project.org/bugzilla,  logging  in  as
       user  bugmail@my-project.org  with password plugh. It is used with a collection of Mercurial repositories
       in /var/local/hg/repos/, with a web interface at http://my-project.org/hg.

       [bugzilla]
       bzurl=http://my-project.org/bugzilla
       user=bugmail@my-project.org
       password=plugh
       version=xmlrpc
       template=Changeset {node|short} in {root|basename}.
                {hgweb}/{webroot}/rev/{node|short}\n
                {desc}\n
       strip=5

       [web]
       baseurl=http://my-project.org/hg

       XMLRPC+email example configuration. This uses the Bugzilla at http://my-project.org/bugzilla, logging  in
       as  user  bugmail@my-project.org  with  password  plugh.  It  is  used  with  a  collection  of Mercurial
       repositories in /var/local/hg/repos/, with a web interface at http://my-project.org/hg. Bug comments  are
       sent to the Bugzilla email address bugzilla@my-project.org.

       [bugzilla]
       bzurl=http://my-project.org/bugzilla
       user=bugmail@my-project.org
       password=plugh
       version=xmlrpc+email
       bzemail=bugzilla@my-project.org
       template=Changeset {node|short} in {root|basename}.
                {hgweb}/{webroot}/rev/{node|short}\n
                {desc}\n
       strip=5

       [web]
       baseurl=http://my-project.org/hg

       [usermap]
       user@emaildomain.com=user.name@bugzilladomain.com

       MySQL  example  configuration. This has a local Bugzilla 3.2 installation in /opt/bugzilla-3.2. The MySQL
       database is on localhost, the Bugzilla database name is bugs and MySQL is accessed  with  MySQL  username
       bugs password XYZZY. It is used with a collection of Mercurial repositories in /var/local/hg/repos/, with
       a web interface at http://my-project.org/hg.

       [bugzilla]
       host=localhost
       password=XYZZY
       version=3.0
       bzuser=unknown@domain.com
       bzdir=/opt/bugzilla-3.2
       template=Changeset {node|short} in {root|basename}.
                {hgweb}/{webroot}/rev/{node|short}\n
                {desc}\n
       strip=5

       [web]
       baseurl=http://my-project.org/hg

       [usermap]
       user@emaildomain.com=user.name@bugzilladomain.com

       All the above add a comment to the Bugzilla bug record of the form:

       Changeset 3b16791d6642 in repository-name.
       http://my-project.org/hg/repository-name/rev/3b16791d6642

       Changeset commit comment. Bug 1234.

   censor
       erase file content at a given revision

       The censor command instructs Mercurial to erase all content  of  a  file  at  a  given  revision  without
       updating  the  changeset  hash.  This  allows  existing  history  to remain valid while preventing future
       clones/pulls from receiving the erased data.

       Typical uses for censor are due to security or legal requirements, including:

       * Passwords, private keys, cryptographic material
       * Licensed data/code/libraries for which the license has expired
       * Personally Identifiable Information or other private data

       Censored nodes can interrupt mercurial's  typical  operation  whenever  the  excised  data  needs  to  be
       materialized.  Some  commands,  like  hg  cat/hg revert, simply fail when asked to produce censored data.
       Others, like hg verify and hg update, must be capable of tolerating censored data to continue to function
       in  a  meaningful  way.  Such  commands  only tolerate censored file revisions if they are allowed by the
       "censor.policy=ignore" config option.

       A few informative commands such as hg grep will unconditionally ignore censored data  and  merely  report
       that it was encountered.

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   censor
       hg censor -r REV [-t TEXT] [FILE]

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              censor file from specified revision

       -t,--tombstone <TEXT>
              replacement tombstone data

   children
       command to display child changesets (DEPRECATED)

       This extension is deprecated. You should use hg log -r "children(REV)" instead.

   Commands
   Change navigation
   children
       show the children of the given or working directory revision:

       hg children [-r REV] [FILE]

       Print  the  children  of  the  working  directory's  revisions.  If a revision is given via -r/--rev, the
       children of that revision will be printed. If a file argument is given, revision in which  the  file  was
       last changed (after the working directory revision or the argument to --rev if given) is printed.

       Please use hg log instead:

       hg children => hg log -r "children(.)"
       hg children -r REV => hg log -r "children(REV)"

       See hg help log and hg help revsets.children.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              show children of the specified revision (default: .)

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   churn
       command to display statistics about repository history

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   churn
       histogram of changes to the repository:

       hg churn [-d DATE] [-r REV] [--aliases FILE] [FILE]

       This  command  will  display  a  histogram representing the number of changed lines or revisions, grouped
       according to the given template. The default template will group changes  by  author.   The  --dateformat
       option may be used to group the results by date instead.

       Statistics are based on the number of changed lines, or alternatively the number of matching revisions if
       the --changesets option is specified.

       Examples:

       # display count of changed lines for every committer
       hg churn -T "{author|email}"

       # display daily activity graph
       hg churn -f "%H" -s -c

       # display activity of developers by month
       hg churn -f "%Y-%m" -s -c

       # display count of lines changed in every year
       hg churn -f "%Y" -s

       It is possible to map alternate email addresses to a main address by providing a file using the following
       format:

       <alias email> = <actual email>

       Such  a  file may be specified with the --aliases option, otherwise a .hgchurn file will be looked for in
       the working directory root.  Aliases will be split from the rightmost "=".

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              count rate for the specified revision or revset

       -d,--date <DATE>
              count rate for revisions matching date spec

       -t,--oldtemplate <TEMPLATE>
              template to group changesets (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              template to group changesets (default: {author|email})

       -f,--dateformat <FORMAT>
              strftime-compatible format for grouping by date

       -c, --changesets
              count rate by number of changesets

       -s, --sort
              sort by key (default: sort by count)

       --diffstat
              display added/removed lines separately

       --aliases <FILE>
              file with email aliases

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   clonebundles
       advertise pre-generated bundles to seed clones

       "clonebundles" is a server-side extension used to advertise the existence  of  pre-generated,  externally
       hosted bundle files to clients that are cloning so that cloning can be faster, more reliable, and require
       less resources on the server. "pullbundles" is a related feature for sending pre-generated  bundle  files
       to clients as part of pull operations.

       Cloning  can be a CPU and I/O intensive operation on servers. Traditionally, the server, in response to a
       client's request to clone, dynamically generates a bundle containing the entire  repository  content  and
       sends  it  to  the  client.   There  is  no caching on the server and the server will have to redundantly
       generate the same outgoing bundle in response to each clone request. For servers with large  repositories
       or with high clone volume, the load from clones can make scaling the server challenging and costly.

       This  extension  provides  server operators the ability to offload potentially expensive clone load to an
       external service. Pre-generated bundles also allow using more CPU  intensive  compression,  reducing  the
       effective bandwidth requirements.

       Here's how clone bundles work:

       1. A server operator establishes a mechanism for making bundle files available on a hosting service where
          Mercurial clients can fetch them.

       2. A manifest file listing available bundle URLs and some optional metadata is  added  to  the  Mercurial
          repository on the server.

       3. A client initiates a clone against a clone bundles aware server.

       4. The  client  sees  the  server is advertising clone bundles and fetches the manifest listing available
          bundles.

       5. The client filters and sorts the available bundles based on what it supports and prefers.

       6. The client downloads and applies an available bundle from the server-specified URL.

       7. The client reconnects to the original server and performs the equivalent of hg  pull to  retrieve  all
          repository data not in the bundle. (The repository could have been updated between when the bundle was
          created and when the client started the clone.) This may use "pullbundles".

       Instead of the server generating full repository bundles for  every  clone  request,  it  generates  full
       bundles once and they are subsequently reused to bootstrap new clones. The server may still transfer data
       at clone time.  However, this is only data that has been added/changed since the bundle was created.  For
       large, established repositories, this can reduce server load for clones to less than 1% of original.

       Here's how pullbundles work:

       1. A  manifest  file  listing  available  bundles  and describing the revisions is added to the Mercurial
          repository on the server.

       2. A new-enough client informs the server that it supports partial pulls and initiates a pull.

       3. If the server has pull bundles enabled and sees the client advertising partial pulls, it checks for  a
          matching  pull bundle in the manifest.  A bundle matches if the format is supported by the client, the
          client has the required revisions already and needs something from the bundle.

       4. If there is at least one matching bundle, the server sends it to the client.

       5. The client applies the bundle and notices that the server reply was incomplete. It  initiates  another
          pull.

       To work, this extension requires the following of server operators:

       • Generating bundle files of repository content (typically periodically, such as once per day).

       • Clone  bundles:  A file server that clients have network access to and that Python knows how to talk to
         through its normal URL handling facility (typically an HTTP/HTTPS server).

       • A process for keeping the bundles manifest in sync with available bundle files.

       Strictly speaking, using a static file hosting server isn't required:  a  server  operator  could  use  a
       dynamic service for retrieving bundle data. However, static file hosting services are simple and scalable
       and should be sufficient for most needs.

       Bundle files can be generated with the hg bundle command. Typically hg bundle --all is used to produce  a
       bundle of the entire repository.

       hg  debugcreatestreamclonebundle can be used to produce a special streaming clonebundle. These are bundle
       files that are extremely efficient to produce and consume (read: fast). However,  they  are  larger  than
       traditional  bundle  formats  and  require  that  clients  support the exact set of repository data store
       formats in use by the repository that created them.  Typically, a newer server can  serve  data  that  is
       compatible  with  older  clients.   However,  streaming  clone  bundles don't have this guarantee. Server
       operators need to be aware  that  newer  versions  of  Mercurial  may  produce  streaming  clone  bundles
       incompatible with older Mercurial versions.

       A  server  operator  is  responsible for creating a .hg/clonebundles.manifest file containing the list of
       available bundle files suitable for seeding clones. If this file does not exist, the repository will  not
       advertise the existence of clone bundles when clients connect. For pull bundles, .hg/pullbundles.manifest
       is used.

       The manifest file contains a newline (n) delimited list of entries.

       Each line in this file defines an available bundle. Lines have the format:

          <URL> [<key>=<value>[ <key>=<value>]]

       That is, a URL followed by an optional, space-delimited list of  key=value  pairs  describing  additional
       properties of this bundle. Both keys and values are URI encoded.

       For pull bundles, the URL is a path under the .hg directory of the repository.

       Keys in UPPERCASE are reserved for use by Mercurial and are defined below.  All non-uppercase keys can be
       used by site installations. An example use for custom properties is to use the  datacenter  attribute  to
       define  which  data  center  a  file  is hosted in. Clients could then prefer a server in the data center
       closest to them.

       The following reserved keys are currently defined:

       BUNDLESPEC
              A "bundle specification" string that describes the type of the bundle.

              These are string values that are accepted by the "--type" argument of hg bundle.

              The values are parsed in strict mode, which means they must be of the "<compression>-<type>" form.
              See mercurial.exchange.parsebundlespec() for more details.

              hg  debugbundle --spec can be used to print the bundle specification string for a bundle file. The
              output of this command can be used verbatim for the value of BUNDLESPEC (it is already escaped).

              Clients will automatically filter out specifications that are unknown or unsupported so they won't
              attempt to download something that likely won't apply.

              The  actual  value  doesn't  impact client behavior beyond filtering: clients will still sniff the
              bundle type from the header of downloaded files.

              Use of this key is highly recommended, as it allows clients to easily skip unsupported bundles. If
              this  key  is  not  defined,  an  old client may attempt to apply a bundle that it is incapable of
              reading.

       REQUIRESNI
              Whether Server Name Indication (SNI) is required to connect to the URL.  SNI allows servers to use
              multiple  certificates  on the same IP. It is somewhat common in CDNs and other hosting providers.
              Older Python versions do not support SNI. Defining  this  attribute  enables  clients  with  older
              Python  versions  to  filter  this  entry without experiencing an opaque SSL failure at connection
              time.

              If this is defined, it is important to advertise a non-SNI fallback URL  or  clients  running  old
              Python releases may not be able to clone with the clonebundles facility.

              Value should be "true".

       heads  Used  for  pull bundles. This contains the ; separated changeset hashes of the heads of the bundle
              content.

       bases  Used for pull bundles. This contains the ; separated changeset hashes of the roots of  the  bundle
              content. This can be skipped if the bundle was created without --base.

       Manifests  can  contain  multiple entries. Assuming metadata is defined, clients will filter entries from
       the manifest that they don't support. The remaining entries are optionally sorted by  client  preferences
       (ui.clonebundleprefers  config  option). The client then attempts to fetch the bundle at the first URL in
       the remaining list.

       Errors when downloading a bundle will fail the entire clone operation: clients do not automatically  fall
       back  to  a  traditional  clone.  The  reason  for this is that if a server is using clone bundles, it is
       probably doing so because the feature is necessary to  help  it  scale.  In  other  words,  there  is  an
       assumption  that  clone  load  will  be  offloaded to another service and that the Mercurial server isn't
       responsible for serving this clone load.  If that other service experiences issues and clients start mass
       falling  back  to  the  original Mercurial server, the added clone load could overwhelm the server due to
       unexpected load and effectively take it offline. Not having clients automatically fall  back  to  cloning
       from the original server mitigates this scenario.

       Because  there  is no automatic Mercurial server fallback on failure of the bundle hosting service, it is
       important for server operators to view the bundle hosting service as an extension of the Mercurial server
       in  terms  of availability and service level agreements: if the bundle hosting service goes down, so does
       the ability for clients to clone. Note: clients will see a message informing them how to bypass the clone
       bundles  facility  when  a  failure  occurs. So server operators should prepare for some people to follow
       these instructions when a failure occurs, thus driving more load to the original  Mercurial  server  when
       the bundle hosting service fails.

   closehead
       close arbitrary heads without checking them out first

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   close-head
       close the given head revisions:

       hg close-head [OPTION]... [REV]...

       This  is  equivalent  to checking out each revision in a clean tree and running hg commit --close-branch,
       except that it doesn't change the working directory.

       The commit message must be specified with -l or -m.

       Options:

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revision to check

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: close-heads

   commitextras
       adds a new flag extras to commit (ADVANCED)

   convert
       import revisions from foreign VCS repositories into Mercurial

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   convert
       convert a foreign SCM repository to a Mercurial one.:

       hg convert [OPTION]... SOURCE [DEST [REVMAP]]

       Accepted source formats [identifiers]:

       • Mercurial [hg]

       • CVS [cvs]

       • Darcs [darcs]

       • git [git]

       • Subversion [svn]

       • Monotone [mtn]

       • GNU Arch [gnuarch]

       • Bazaar [bzr]

       • Perforce [p4]

       Accepted destination formats [identifiers]:

       • Mercurial [hg]

       • Subversion [svn] (history on branches is not preserved)

       If no revision is given, all revisions will be converted.  Otherwise, convert will only import up to  the
       named revision (given in a format understood by the source).

       If  no  destination  directory  name  is  specified,  it  defaults to the basename of the source with -hg
       appended. If the destination repository doesn't exist, it will be created.

       By default, all sources except Mercurial will use --branchsort.  Mercurial uses --sourcesort to  preserve
       original revision numbers order. Sort modes have the following effects:

       --branchsort
              convert  from  parent  to child revision when possible, which means branches are usually converted
              one after the other. It generates more compact repositories.

       --datesort
              sort revisions by date. Converted repositories have good-looking changelogs but are often an order
              of magnitude larger than the same ones generated by --branchsort.

       --sourcesort
              try to preserve source revisions order, only supported by Mercurial sources.

       --closesort
              try  to move closed revisions as close as possible to parent branches, only supported by Mercurial
              sources.

       If REVMAP isn't given, it will be put in a default location (<dest>/.hg/shamap by default). The REVMAP is
       a simple text file that maps each source commit ID to the destination ID for that revision, like so:

       <source ID> <destination ID>

       If  the file doesn't exist, it's automatically created. It's updated on each commit copied, so hg convert
       can be interrupted and can be run repeatedly to copy new commits.

       The authormap is a simple text file that maps each source commit author to a destination  commit  author.
       It  is  handy  for  source SCMs that use unix logins to identify authors (e.g.: CVS). One line per author
       mapping and the line format is:

       source author = destination author

       Empty lines and lines starting with a # are ignored.

       The filemap is a file that allows filtering and remapping of files and directories. Each line can contain
       one of the following directives:

       include path/to/file-or-dir

       exclude path/to/file-or-dir

       rename path/to/source path/to/destination

       Comment lines start with #. A specified path matches if it equals the full relative name of a file or one
       of its parent directories. The include or exclude directive with the longest matching  path  applies,  so
       line order does not matter.

       The  include  directive  causes a file, or all files under a directory, to be included in the destination
       repository. The default if there are no include statements is to include everything.  If  there  are  any
       include  statements,  nothing  else is included.  The exclude directive causes files or directories to be
       omitted. The rename directive renames a  file  or  directory  if  it  is  converted.  To  rename  from  a
       subdirectory into the root of the repository, use . as the path to rename to.

       --full will make sure the converted changesets contain exactly the right files with the right content. It
       will make a full conversion of all files, not just the ones that have changed.  Files  that  already  are
       correct  will  not  be  changed. This can be used to apply filemap changes when converting incrementally.
       This is currently only supported for Mercurial and Subversion.

       The splicemap is a file that allows insertion of synthetic history, letting you specify the parents of  a
       revision.  This  is  useful  if  you  want  to  e.g.  give  a  Subversion merge two parents, or graft two
       disconnected series of history together. Each entry contains a key, followed by a space, followed by  one
       or two comma-separated values:

       key parent1, parent2

       The  key  is the revision ID in the source revision control system whose parents should be modified (same
       format as a key in .hg/shamap). The values are the revision IDs (in  either  the  source  or  destination
       revision  control  system) that should be used as the new parents for that node. For example, if you have
       merged "release-1.0" into "trunk", then you should specify the revision on "trunk" as  the  first  parent
       and the one on the "release-1.0" branch as the second.

       The  branchmap  is  a  file  that allows you to rename a branch when it is being brought in from whatever
       external repository. When used in conjunction with a splicemap, it allows for a powerful  combination  to
       help  fix  even  the  most  badly  mismanaged repositories and turn them into nicely structured Mercurial
       repositories. The branchmap contains lines of the form:

       original_branch_name new_branch_name

       where "original_branch_name" is the name of the branch in the source repository, and "new_branch_name" is
       the  name  of  the branch is the destination repository. No whitespace is allowed in the new branch name.
       This can be used to (for instance) move code in one repository from "default" to a named branch.

   Mercurial Source
       The Mercurial source recognizes the following configuration options, which you can  set  on  the  command
       line with --config:

       convert.hg.ignoreerrors
              ignore  integrity errors when reading.  Use it to fix Mercurial repositories with missing revlogs,
              by converting from and to Mercurial. Default is False.

       convert.hg.saverev
              store original revision ID in changeset (forces target IDs to change). It takes a boolean argument
              and defaults to False.

       convert.hg.startrev
              specify the initial Mercurial revision.  The default is 0.

       convert.hg.revs
              revset specifying the source revisions to convert.

   Bazaar Source
       The following options can be used with --config:

       convert.bzr.saverev
              whether  to  store  the  original  Bazaar commit ID in the metadata of the destination commit. The
              default is True.

   CVS Source
       CVS source will use a sandbox (i.e. a checked-out copy) from CVS to indicate the starting point  of  what
       will  be  converted. Direct access to the repository files is not needed, unless of course the repository
       is :local:. The conversion uses the top level directory in the sandbox to find the  CVS  repository,  and
       then  uses  CVS  rlog  commands  to find files to convert. This means that unless a filemap is given, all
       files under the starting directory will be converted, and that any directory reorganization  in  the  CVS
       sandbox is ignored.

       The following options can be used with --config:

       convert.cvsps.cache
              Set to False to disable remote log caching, for testing and debugging purposes. Default is True.

       convert.cvsps.fuzz
              Specify  the maximum time (in seconds) that is allowed between commits with identical user and log
              message in a single changeset. When very large files were checked in as part of a  changeset  then
              the default may not be long enough.  The default is 60.

       convert.cvsps.logencoding
              Specify  encoding name to be used for transcoding CVS log messages. Multiple encoding names can be
              specified as a list (see hg help config.Syntax), but only the first  acceptable  encoding  in  the
              list is used per CVS log entries. This transcoding is executed before cvslog hook below.

       convert.cvsps.mergeto
              Specify a regular expression to which commit log messages are matched. If a match occurs, then the
              conversion process will insert a dummy revision merging the  branch  on  which  this  log  message
              occurs to the branch indicated in the regex. Default is {{mergetobranch ([-\w]+)}}

       convert.cvsps.mergefrom
              Specify a regular expression to which commit log messages are matched. If a match occurs, then the
              conversion process will add the most recent revision on the branch indicated in the regex  as  the
              second parent of the changeset. Default is {{mergefrombranch ([-\w]+)}}

       convert.localtimezone
              use  local  time  (as  determined  by  the  TZ environment variable) for changeset date/times. The
              default is False (use UTC).

       hooks.cvslog
              Specify a Python function to be called at the end of gathering the CVS log. The function is passed
              a list with the log entries, and can modify the entries in-place, or add or delete them.

       hooks.cvschangesets
              Specify  a  Python function to be called after the changesets are calculated from the CVS log. The
              function is passed a list with the changeset entries, and can modify the changesets  in-place,  or
              add or delete them.

       An  additional "debugcvsps" Mercurial command allows the builtin changeset merging code to be run without
       doing a conversion. Its parameters and output are similar to that of cvsps 2.1. Please  see  the  command
       help for more details.

   Subversion Source
       Subversion   source   detects   classical   trunk/branches/tags   layouts.    By  default,  the  supplied
       svn://repo/path/ source URL is converted as a single branch. If svn://repo/path/trunk exists it  replaces
       the  default  branch.  If  svn://repo/path/branches  exists,  its  subdirectories  are listed as possible
       branches. If svn://repo/path/tags exists, it is looked for tags referencing converted  branches.  Default
       trunk,  branches  and tags values can be overridden with following options. Set them to paths relative to
       the source URL, or leave them blank to disable auto detection.

       The following options can be set with --config:

       convert.svn.branches
              specify the directory containing branches.  The default is branches.

       convert.svn.tags
              specify the directory containing tags. The default is tags.

       convert.svn.trunk
              specify the name of the trunk branch. The default is trunk.

       convert.localtimezone
              use local time (as determined by the  TZ  environment  variable)  for  changeset  date/times.  The
              default is False (use UTC).

       Source  history  can be retrieved starting at a specific revision, instead of being integrally converted.
       Only single branch conversions are supported.

       convert.svn.startrev
              specify start Subversion revision number.  The default is 0.

   Git Source
       The Git importer converts commits from all reachable branches (refs in refs/heads) and remotes  (refs  in
       refs/remotes)  to  Mercurial.   Branches  are converted to bookmarks with the same name, with the leading
       'refs/heads' stripped. Git submodules are converted to Git subrepos in Mercurial.

       The following options can be set with --config:

       convert.git.similarity
              specify how similar files modified in a commit must be to be imported as renames or copies,  as  a
              percentage  between  0  (disabled) and 100 (files must be identical). For example, 90 means that a
              delete/add pair will be imported as a rename if more than 90% of  the  file  hasn't  changed.  The
              default is 50.

       convert.git.findcopiesharder
              while  detecting  copies, look at all files in the working copy instead of just changed ones. This
              is very expensive for large projects, and is only effective when convert.git.similarity is greater
              than 0. The default is False.

       convert.git.renamelimit
              perform  rename and copy detection up to this many changed files in a commit. Increasing this will
              make rename and copy detection more accurate but will significantly slow down computation on large
              projects.  The option is only relevant if convert.git.similarity is greater than 0. The default is
              400.

       convert.git.committeractions
              list of actions to take when processing author and committer values.

              Git commits have separate author (who wrote the commit) and committer  (who  applied  the  commit)
              fields.  Not  all destinations support separate author and committer fields (including Mercurial).
              This config option controls what to do with these author and committer fields during conversion.

              A value of messagedifferent will append a committer: ...  line to the commit message  if  the  Git
              committer  is different from the author. The prefix of that line can be specified using the syntax
              messagedifferent=<prefix>. e.g. messagedifferent=git-committer:.  When a prefix  is  specified,  a
              space will always be inserted between the prefix and the value.

              messagealways  behaves like messagedifferent except it will always result in a committer: ... line
              being appended to the commit message. This value is mutually exclusive with messagedifferent.

              dropcommitter will remove references to the committer. Only references to the author will  remain.
              Actions that add references to the committer will have no effect when this is set.

              replaceauthor  will  replace  the value of the author field with the committer. Other actions that
              add references to the committer will still take effect when this is set.

              The default is messagedifferent.

       convert.git.extrakeys
              list of extra keys from commit metadata to copy to the destination. Some  Git  repositories  store
              extra  metadata in commits.  By default, this non-default metadata will be lost during conversion.
              Setting this config option can retain that metadata. Some built-in keys such as parent and  branch
              are not allowed to be copied.

       convert.git.remoteprefix
              remote  refs are converted as bookmarks with convert.git.remoteprefix as a prefix followed by a /.
              The default is 'remote'.

       convert.git.saverev
              whether to store the original Git commit ID in the metadata of the destination commit. The default
              is True.

       convert.git.skipsubmodules
              does  not  convert  root level .gitmodules files or files with 160000 mode indicating a submodule.
              Default is False.

   Perforce Source
       The Perforce (P4) importer can be given a p4 depot path or a client  specification  as  source.  It  will
       convert  all  files  in  the  source  to  a  flat  Mercurial  repository,  ignoring  labels, branches and
       integrations. Note that when a depot path is given you then usually should specify  a  target  directory,
       because otherwise the target may be named ...-hg.

       The following options can be set with --config:

       convert.p4.encoding
              specify  the  encoding to use when decoding standard output of the Perforce command line tool. The
              default is default system encoding.

       convert.p4.startrev
              specify initial Perforce revision (a Perforce changelist number).

   Mercurial Destination
       The Mercurial destination will recognize Mercurial subrepositories  in  the  destination  directory,  and
       update   the   .hgsubstate   file   automatically   if   the   destination  subrepositories  contain  the
       <dest>/<sub>/.hg/shamap file.  Converting a repository with subrepositories requires converting a  single
       repository at a time, from the bottom up.

       An example showing how to convert a repository with subrepositories:

       # so convert knows the type when it sees a non empty destination
       $ hg init converted

       $ hg convert orig/sub1 converted/sub1
       $ hg convert orig/sub2 converted/sub2
       $ hg convert orig converted

       The following options are supported:

       convert.hg.clonebranches
              dispatch source branches in separate clones. The default is False.

       convert.hg.tagsbranch
              branch name for tag revisions, defaults to default.

       convert.hg.usebranchnames
              preserve branch names. The default is True.

       convert.hg.sourcename
              records  the  given  string  as  a  'convert_source' extra value on each commit made in the target
              repository. The default is None.

       convert.hg.preserve-hash
              only works with mercurial sources. Make convert prevent performance improvement  to  the  list  of
              modified  files  in  commits  when such an improvement would cause the hash of a commit to change.
              The default is False.

   All Destinations
       All destination types accept the following options:

       convert.skiptags
              does not convert tags from the source repo to the target repo. The default is False.

       Options:

       --authors <FILE>
              username mapping filename (DEPRECATED) (use --authormap instead)

       -s,--source-type <TYPE>
              source repository type

       -d,--dest-type <TYPE>
              destination repository type

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              import up to source revision REV

       -A,--authormap <FILE>
              remap usernames using this file

       --filemap <FILE>
              remap file names using contents of file

       --full apply filemap changes by converting all files again

       --splicemap <FILE>
              splice synthesized history into place

       --branchmap <FILE>
              change branch names while converting

       --branchsort
              try to sort changesets by branches

       --datesort
              try to sort changesets by date

       --sourcesort
              preserve source changesets order

       --closesort
              try to reorder closed revisions

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   eol
       automatically manage newlines in repository files

       This extension allows you to manage the type of line endings (CRLF or LF) that are used in the repository
       and in the local working directory. That way you can get CRLF line endings on Windows and LF on Unix/Mac,
       thereby letting everybody use their OS native line endings.

       The extension reads its configuration from a versioned .hgeol configuration file found in the root of the
       working  directory.  The  .hgeol  file use the same syntax as all other Mercurial configuration files. It
       uses two sections, [patterns] and [repository].

       The [patterns] section specifies how line endings should be converted between the working  directory  and
       the  repository. The format is specified by a file pattern. The first match is used, so put more specific
       patterns first. The available line endings are LF, CRLF, and BIN.

       Files with the declared format of CRLF or LF are always checked out and stored in the repository in  that
       format  and  files  declared  to be binary (BIN) are left unchanged. Additionally, native is an alias for
       checking out in the platform's default line ending: LF on Unix (including Mac OS X) and CRLF on  Windows.
       Note that BIN (do nothing to line endings) is Mercurial's default behavior; it is only needed if you need
       to override a later, more general pattern.

       The optional [repository] section specifies the line endings to use for files stored in  the  repository.
       It  has  a single setting, native, which determines the storage line endings for files declared as native
       in the [patterns] section. It can be set to LF or CRLF. The default is LF. For example, this  means  that
       on  Windows,  files  configured  as  native  (CRLF by default) will be converted to LF when stored in the
       repository. Files declared as LF, CRLF, or BIN in the [patterns] section are always stored as-is  in  the
       repository.

       Example versioned .hgeol file:

       [patterns]
       **.py = native
       **.vcproj = CRLF
       **.txt = native
       Makefile = LF
       **.jpg = BIN

       [repository]
       native = LF

       Note   The  rules  will  first apply when files are touched in the working directory, e.g. by updating to
              null and back to tip to touch all files.

       The extension uses an optional [eol] section read from both the normal Mercurial configuration files  and
       the  .hgeol  file, with the latter overriding the former. You can use that section to control the overall
       behavior. There are three settings:

       • eol.native (default os.linesep) can be set to LF or CRLF to  override  the  default  interpretation  of
         native  for checkout. This can be used with hg archive on Unix, say, to generate an archive where files
         have line endings for Windows.

       • eol.only-consistent (default True) can be set to  False  to  make  the  extension  convert  files  with
         inconsistent  EOLs.  Inconsistent means that there is both CRLF and LF present in the file.  Such files
         are normally not touched under the assumption that they have mixed EOLs on purpose.

       • eol.fix-trailing-newline (default False) can be set to True to ensure that converted files end  with  a
         EOL character (either \n or \r\n as per the configured patterns).

       The  extension  provides  cleverencode: and cleverdecode: filters like the deprecated win32text extension
       does. This means that you can disable win32text and enable eol and your filters will still work. You only
       need to these filters until you have prepared a .hgeol file.

       The  win32text.forbid*  hooks  provided  by  the win32text extension have been unified into a single hook
       named eol.checkheadshook. The hook will lookup the expected line endings  from  the  .hgeol  file,  which
       means  you  must  migrate  to  a  .hgeol file first before using the hook. eol.checkheadshook only checks
       heads, intermediate invalid revisions will be pushed. To forbid them completely, use the eol.checkallhook
       hook. These hooks are best used as pretxnchangegroup hooks.

       See hg help patterns for more information about the glob patterns used.

   extdiff
       command to allow external programs to compare revisions

       The  extdiff  Mercurial  extension  allows you to use external programs to compare revisions, or revision
       with working directory. The external diff programs are called with a configurable set of options and  two
       non-option arguments: paths to directories containing snapshots of files to compare.

       If  there  is  more  than  one file being compared and the "child" revision is the working directory, any
       modifications made in the external diff program will be copied back to the  working  directory  from  the
       temporary directory.

       The  extdiff  extension  also  allows  you  to configure new diff commands, so you do not need to type hg
       extdiff -p kdiff3 always.

       [extdiff]
       # add new command that runs GNU diff(1) in 'context diff' mode
       cdiff = gdiff -Nprc5
       ## or the old way:
       #cmd.cdiff = gdiff
       #opts.cdiff = -Nprc5

       # add new command called meld, runs meld (no need to name twice).  If
       # the meld executable is not available, the meld tool in [merge-tools]
       # will be used, if available
       meld =

       # add new command called vimdiff, runs gvimdiff with DirDiff plugin
       # (see http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=102) Non
       # English user, be sure to put "let g:DirDiffDynamicDiffText = 1" in
       # your .vimrc
       vimdiff = gvim -f "+next" \
                 "+execute 'DirDiff' fnameescape(argv(0)) fnameescape(argv(1))"

       Tool arguments can include variables that are expanded at runtime:

       $parent1, $plabel1 - filename, descriptive label of first parent
       $child,   $clabel  - filename, descriptive label of child revision
       $parent2, $plabel2 - filename, descriptive label of second parent
       $root              - repository root
       $parent is an alias for $parent1.

       The extdiff extension will look in your [diff-tools] and [merge-tools] sections for diff tool  arguments,
       when none are specified in [extdiff].

       [extdiff]
       kdiff3 =

       [diff-tools]
       kdiff3.diffargs=--L1 '$plabel1' --L2 '$clabel' $parent $child

       If  a  program  has  a  graphical  interface, it might be interesting to tell Mercurial about it. It will
       prevent the program from being mistakenly used in a terminal-only environment (such as  an  SSH  terminal
       session),  and will make hg extdiff --per-file open multiple file diffs at once instead of one by one (if
       you still want to open file diffs one by one, you can use the --confirm option).

       Declaring that a tool has a graphical interface can be done with the gui flag next to where diffargs  are
       specified:

       [diff-tools]
       kdiff3.diffargs=--L1 '$plabel1' --L2 '$clabel' $parent $child
       kdiff3.gui = true

       You  can use -I/-X and list of file or directory names like normal hg diff command. The extdiff extension
       makes snapshots of only needed files, so running the external diff program will actually be  pretty  fast
       (at least faster than having to compare the entire tree).

   Commands
   File content management
   extdiff
       use external program to diff repository (or selected files):

       hg extdiff [OPT]... [FILE]...

       Show  differences  between  revisions  for  the  specified  files, using an external program. The default
       program used is diff, with default options "-Npru".

       To select a different program, use the -p/--program option. The program will be passed the names  of  two
       directories to compare, unless the --per-file option is specified (see below). To pass additional options
       to the program, use -o/--option. These will be passed before the names of the  directories  or  files  to
       compare.

       When  two  revision  arguments  are  given,  then  changes are shown between those revisions. If only one
       revision is specified then that revision is compared to the working directory, and, when no revisions are
       specified, the working directory files are compared to its parent.

       The  --per-file  option runs the external program repeatedly on each file to diff, instead of once on two
       directories. By default, this happens one by one, where the next  file  diff  is  open  in  the  external
       program  only once the previous external program (for the previous file diff) has exited. If the external
       program has a graphical interface, it can open all the file diffs at once instead of one by one.  See  hg
       help  -e  extdiff for  information  about  how  to  tell  Mercurial  that a given program has a graphical
       interface.

       The --confirm option will prompt the user before each invocation of the external program. It  is  ignored
       if --per-file isn't specified.

       Options:

       -p,--program <CMD>
              comparison program to run

       -o,--option <OPT[+]>
              pass option to comparison program

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revision

       -c,--change <REV>
              change made by revision

       --per-file
              compare each file instead of revision snapshots

       --confirm
              prompt user before each external program invocation

       --patch
              compare patches for two revisions

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   factotum
       http authentication with factotum

       This  extension  allows  the  factotum(4)  facility  on  Plan  9  from  Bell  Labs  platforms  to provide
       authentication information for HTTP access. Configuration entries specified in the auth section  as  well
       as  authentication  information  provided  in  the  repository  URL  are fully supported. If no prefix is
       specified, a value of "*" will be assumed.

       By default, keys are specified as:

       proto=pass service=hg prefix=<prefix> user=<username> !password=<password>

       If the factotum extension is unable to read the required key, one will be requested interactively.

       A configuration section is available to customize runtime behavior. By default, these entries are:

       [factotum]
       executable = /bin/auth/factotum
       mountpoint = /mnt/factotum
       service = hg

       The executable entry defines the full path to the factotum binary. The mountpoint entry defines the  path
       to the factotum file service. Lastly, the service entry controls the service name used when reading keys.

   fastannotate
       yet another annotate implementation that might be faster (EXPERIMENTAL)

       The fastannotate extension provides a 'fastannotate' command that makes use of the linelog data structure
       as a cache layer and is expected to be faster than the vanilla 'annotate' if the cache is present.

       In most cases, fastannotate requires a setup that mainbranch is some pointer that always  moves  forward,
       to be most efficient.

       Using  fastannotate  together  with  linkrevcache would speed up building the annotate cache greatly. Run
       "debugbuildlinkrevcache" before "debugbuildannotatecache".

       [fastannotate]
       # specify the main branch head. the internal linelog will only contain
       # the linear (ignoring p2) "mainbranch". since linelog cannot move
       # backwards without a rebuild, this should be something that always moves
       # forward, usually it is "master" or "@".
       mainbranch = master

       # fastannotate supports different modes to expose its feature.
       # a list of combination:
       # - fastannotate: expose the feature via the "fastannotate" command which
       #   deals with everything in a most efficient way, and provides extra
       #   features like --deleted etc.
       # - fctx: replace fctx.annotate implementation. note:
       #     a. it is less efficient than the "fastannotate" command
       #     b. it will make it practically impossible to access the old (disk
       #        side-effect free) annotate implementation
       #     c. it implies "hgweb".
       # - hgweb: replace hgweb's annotate implementation. conflict with "fctx".
       # (default: fastannotate)
       modes = fastannotate

       # default format when no format flags are used (default: number)
       defaultformat = changeset, user, date

       # serve the annotate cache via wire protocol (default: False)
       # tip: the .hg/fastannotate directory is portable - can be rsynced
       server = True

       # build annotate cache on demand for every client request (default: True)
       # disabling it could make server response faster, useful when there is a
       # cronjob building the cache.
       serverbuildondemand = True

       # update local annotate cache from remote on demand
       client = False

       # path to use when connecting to the remote server (default: default)
       remotepath = default

       # minimal length of the history of a file required to fetch linelog from
       # the server. (default: 10)
       clientfetchthreshold = 10

       # for "fctx" mode, always follow renames regardless of command line option.
       # this is a BC with the original command but will reduced the space needed
       # for annotate cache, and is useful for client-server setup since the
       # server will only provide annotate cache with default options (i.e. with
       # follow). do not affect "fastannotate" mode. (default: True)
       forcefollow = True

       # for "fctx" mode, always treat file as text files, to skip the "isbinary"
       # check. this is consistent with the "fastannotate" command and could help
       # to avoid a file fetch if remotefilelog is used. (default: True)
       forcetext = True

       # use unfiltered repo for better performance.
       unfilteredrepo = True

       # sacrifice correctness in some corner cases for performance. it does not
       # affect the correctness of the annotate cache being built. the option
       # is experimental and may disappear in the future (default: False)
       perfhack = True

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   fetch
       pull, update and merge in one command (DEPRECATED)

   Commands
   Remote repository management
   fetch
       pull changes from a remote repository, merge new changes if needed.:

       hg fetch [SOURCE]

       This finds all changes from the repository at the specified path or  URL  and  adds  them  to  the  local
       repository.

       If  the  pulled  changes  add  a new branch head, the head is automatically merged, and the result of the
       merge is committed.  Otherwise, the working directory is updated to include the new changes.

       When a merge is needed, the working directory is first updated to the newly pulled changes. Local changes
       are then merged into the pulled changes. To switch the merge order, use --switch-parent.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a specific revision you would like to pull

       --edit invoke editor on commit messages

       --force-editor
              edit commit message (DEPRECATED)

       --switch-parent
              switch parents when merging

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   fix
       rewrite file content in changesets or working copy (EXPERIMENTAL)

       Provides  a  command that runs configured tools on the contents of modified files, writing back any fixes
       to the working copy or replacing changesets.

       Here is an example configuration that causes hg fix to apply automatic formatting fixes to modified lines
       in C++ code:

       [fix]
       clang-format:command=clang-format --assume-filename={rootpath}
       clang-format:linerange=--lines={first}:{last}
       clang-format:pattern=set:**.cpp or **.hpp

       The  :command  suboption  forms  the first part of the shell command that will be used to fix a file. The
       content of the file is passed on standard input, and the fixed  file  content  is  expected  on  standard
       output.  Any output on standard error will be displayed as a warning. If the exit status is not zero, the
       file will not be affected. A placeholder warning is displayed if there is a non-zero exit status  but  no
       standard error output. Some values may be substituted into the command:

       {rootpath}  The path of the file being fixed, relative to the repo root
       {basename}  The name of the file being fixed, without the directory path

       If  the  :linerange suboption is set, the tool will only be run if there are changed lines in a file. The
       value of this suboption is appended to the shell command once for every range of  changed  lines  in  the
       file. Some values may be substituted into the command:

       {first}   The 1-based line number of the first line in the modified range
       {last}    The 1-based line number of the last line in the modified range

       Deleted sections of a file will be ignored by :linerange, because there is no corresponding line range in
       the version being fixed.

       By default, tools that set :linerange will only be executed if there is at least one changed line  range.
       This  is  meant  to  prevent  accidents  like running a code formatter in such a way that it unexpectedly
       reformats the whole file. If such a tool  needs  to  operate  on  unchanged  files,  it  should  set  the
       :skipclean suboption to false.

       The  :pattern  suboption  determines which files will be passed through each configured tool. See hg help
       patterns for possible values. However, all patterns are relative to the repo root, even if that text says
       they  are  relative  to  the  current  working  directory.  If  there  are  file arguments to hg fix, the
       intersection of these patterns is used.

       There is also a configurable limit for the maximum size of file that will be processed by hg fix:

       [fix]
       maxfilesize = 2MB

       Normally, execution of configured tools will continue after a  failure  (indicated  by  a  non-zero  exit
       status).  It  can  also  be  configured  to  abort after the first such failure, so that no files will be
       affected if any tool fails. This abort will also cause hg fix to exit with a non-zero status:

       [fix]
       failure = abort

       When multiple tools are configured to affect a file, they execute in an order defined  by  the  :priority
       suboption.  The priority suboption has a default value of zero for each tool. Tools are executed in order
       of descending priority. The execution order of tools with equal priority is unspecified. For example, you
       could use the 'sort' and 'head' utilities to keep only the 10 smallest numbers in a text file by ensuring
       that 'sort' runs before 'head':

       [fix]
       sort:command = sort -n
       head:command = head -n 10
       sort:pattern = numbers.txt
       head:pattern = numbers.txt
       sort:priority = 2
       head:priority = 1

       To account for changes made by each tool, the line numbers used for incremental formatting are recomputed
       before  executing  the  next  tool. So, each tool may see different values for the arguments added by the
       :linerange suboption.

       Each fixer tool is allowed to return some metadata in addition to the fixed file  content.  The  metadata
       must  be  placed  before  the file content on stdout, separated from the file content by a zero byte. The
       metadata is parsed as a JSON value (so, it should be UTF-8 encoded and contain no zero  bytes).  A  fixer
       tool is expected to produce this metadata encoding if and only if the :metadata suboption is true:

       [fix]
       tool:command = tool --prepend-json-metadata
       tool:metadata = true

       The  metadata  values  are  passed  to  hooks,  which  can  be  used  to print summaries or perform other
       post-fixing work. The supported hooks are:

       "postfixfile"
         Run once for each file in each revision where any fixer tools made changes
         to the file content. Provides "$HG_REV" and "$HG_PATH" to identify the file,
         and "$HG_METADATA" with a map of fixer names to metadata values from fixer
         tools that affected the file. Fixer tools that didn't affect the file have a
         value of None. Only fixer tools that executed are present in the metadata.

       "postfix"
         Run once after all files and revisions have been handled. Provides
         "$HG_REPLACEMENTS" with information about what revisions were created and
         made obsolete. Provides a boolean "$HG_WDIRWRITTEN" to indicate whether any
         files in the working copy were updated. Provides a list "$HG_METADATA"
         mapping fixer tool names to lists of metadata values returned from
         executions that modified a file. This aggregates the same metadata
         previously passed to the "postfixfile" hook.

       Fixer tools are run in the repository's root directory. This allows them to read configuration files from
       the  working  copy,  or  even  write  to  the working copy.  The working copy is not updated to match the
       revision being fixed. In fact, several revisions may be fixed in parallel. Writes to the working copy are
       not  amended  into  the  revision being fixed; fixer tools should always write fixed file content back to
       stdout as documented above.

   Commands
   File content management
   fix
       rewrite file content in changesets or working directory:

       hg fix [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Runs any configured tools to fix the content of files. Only  affects  files  with  changes,  unless  file
       arguments  are provided. Only affects changed lines of files, unless the --whole flag is used. Some tools
       may always affect the whole file regardless of --whole.

       If revisions are specified with --rev, those revisions will be checked, and they may be replaced with new
       revisions  that  have  fixed  file content.  It is desirable to specify all descendants of each specified
       revision, so that the fixes propagate to the descendants. If all descendants are fixed at the same  time,
       no merging, rebasing, or evolution will be required.

       If  --working-dir  is  used,  files  with  uncommitted  changes in the working copy will be fixed. If the
       checked-out revision is also fixed, the working directory will update to the replacement revision.

       When determining what lines of each file to fix at each revision, the whole set of revisions being  fixed
       is considered, so that fixes to earlier revisions are not forgotten in later ones. The --base flag can be
       used to override this default behavior, though it is not usually desirable to do so.

       Options:

       --all  fix all non-public non-obsolete revisions

       --base <REV[+]>
              revisions to diff against (overrides automatic selection, and  applies  to  every  revision  being
              fixed)

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revisions to fix

       -w, --working-dir
              fix the working directory

       --whole
              always fix every line of a file

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   fsmonitor
       Faster status operations with the Watchman file monitor (EXPERIMENTAL)

       Integrates the file-watching program Watchman with Mercurial to produce faster status results.

       On a particular Linux system, for a real-world repository with over 400,000 files hosted on ext4, vanilla
       hg status takes 1.3 seconds. On the same system, with fsmonitor it takes about 0.3 seconds.

       fsmonitor requires no configuration -- it will tell Watchman about your repository as  necessary.  You'll
       need to install Watchman from https://facebook.github.io/watchman/ and make sure it is in your PATH.

       fsmonitor is incompatible with the largefiles and eol extensions, and will disable itself if any of those
       are active.

       The following configuration options exist:

       [fsmonitor]
       mode = {off, on, paranoid}

       When mode = off, fsmonitor will disable itself (similar to not loading the extension at all). When mode =
       on,  fsmonitor  will  be enabled (the default).  When mode = paranoid, fsmonitor will query both Watchman
       and the filesystem, and ensure that the results are consistent.

       [fsmonitor]
       timeout = (float)

       A value, in seconds, that determines how long  fsmonitor  will  wait  for  Watchman  to  return  results.
       Defaults to 2.0.

       [fsmonitor]
       blacklistusers = (list of userids)

       A list of usernames for which fsmonitor will disable itself altogether.

       [fsmonitor]
       walk_on_invalidate = (boolean)

       Whether  or  not to walk the whole repo ourselves when our cached state has been invalidated, for example
       when Watchman has been restarted or .hgignore rules have been changed. Walking the repo in that case  can
       result  in competing for I/O with Watchman. For large repos it is recommended to set this value to false.
       You may wish to set this to true if you have a very fast filesystem that can outpace the IPC overhead  of
       getting the result data for the full repo from Watchman. Defaults to false.

       [fsmonitor]
       warn_when_unused = (boolean)

       Whether  to  print  a warning during certain operations when fsmonitor would be beneficial to performance
       but isn't enabled.

       [fsmonitor]
       warn_update_file_count = (integer)

       If warn_when_unused is set and fsmonitor  isn't  enabled,  a  warning  will  be  printed  during  working
       directory updates if this many files will be created.

   githelp
       try mapping git commands to Mercurial commands

       Tries to map a given git command to a Mercurial command:

          $ hg githelp -- git checkout master hg update master

       If an unknown command or parameter combination is detected, an error is produced.

   Commands
   Help
   githelp
       suggests the Mercurial equivalent of the given git command:

       hg githelp

       Usage: hg githelp -- <git command>

          aliases: git

   gpg
       commands to sign and verify changesets

   Commands
   Signing changes (GPG)
   sigcheck
       verify all the signatures there may be for a particular revision:

       hg sigcheck REV

       verify all the signatures there may be for a particular revision

   sign
       add a signature for the current or given revision:

       hg sign [OPTION]... [REV]...

       If  no  revision  is given, the parent of the working directory is used, or tip if no revision is checked
       out.

       The gpg.cmd config setting can be used to specify the command to run. A default key can be specified with
       gpg.key.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       Options:

       -l, --local
              make the signature local

       -f, --force
              sign even if the sigfile is modified

       --no-commit
              do not commit the sigfile after signing

       -k,--key <ID>
              the key id to sign with

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

   sigs
       list signed changesets:

       hg sigs

       list signed changesets

   graphlog
       command to view revision graphs from a shell (DEPRECATED)

       The  functionality  of this extension has been include in core Mercurial since version 2.3. Please use hg
       log -G ... instead.

       This extension adds a --graph option to the incoming, outgoing and log commands.  When  this  options  is
       given, an ASCII representation of the revision graph is also shown.

   Commands
   Change navigation
   glog
       show revision history alongside an ASCII revision graph:

       hg glog [OPTION]... [FILE]

       Print a revision history alongside a revision graph drawn with ASCII characters.

       Nodes printed as an @ character are parents of the working directory.

       This is an alias to hg log -G.

       Options:

       -f, --follow
              follow changeset history, or file history across copies and renames

       --follow-first
              only follow the first parent of merge changesets (DEPRECATED)

       -d,--date <DATE>
              show revisions matching date spec

       -C, --copies
              show copied files

       -k,--keyword <TEXT[+]>
              do case-insensitive search for a given text

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              show the specified revision or revset

       --removed
              include revisions where files were removed

       -m, --only-merges
              show only merges (DEPRECATED)

       -u,--user <USER[+]>
              revisions committed by user

       --only-branch <BRANCH[+]>
              show only changesets within the given named branch (DEPRECATED)

       -b,--branch <BRANCH[+]>
              show changesets within the given named branch

       -P,--prune <REV[+]>
              do not display revision or any of its ancestors

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

       -M, --no-merges
              do not show merges

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       -G, --graph
              show the revision DAG

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   hgk
       browse the repository in a graphical way

       The  hgk  extension  allows  browsing  the history of a repository in a graphical way. It requires Tcl/Tk
       version 8.4 or later. (Tcl/Tk is not distributed with Mercurial.)

       hgk consists of two parts: a Tcl script that does the displaying and  querying  of  information,  and  an
       extension to Mercurial named hgk.py, which provides hooks for hgk to get information. hgk can be found in
       the contrib directory, and the extension is shipped in the hgext repository, and needs to be enabled.

       The hg view command will launch the hgk Tcl script. For this command to work, hgk must be in your  search
       path. Alternately, you can specify the path to hgk in your configuration file:

       [hgk]
       path = /location/of/hgk

       hgk  can  make  use of the extdiff extension to visualize revisions.  Assuming you had already configured
       extdiff vdiff command, just add:

       [hgk]
       vdiff=vdiff

       Revisions context menu will now display  additional  entries  to  fire  vdiff  on  hovered  and  selected
       revisions.

   Commands
   Change navigation
   view
       start interactive history viewer:

       hg view [-l LIMIT] [REVRANGE]

       start interactive history viewer

       Options:

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

   Uncategorized commands
   highlight
       syntax highlighting for hgweb (requires Pygments)

       It depends on the Pygments syntax highlighting library: http://pygments.org/

       There are the following configuration options:

       [web]
       pygments_style = <style> (default: colorful)
       highlightfiles = <fileset> (default: size('<5M'))
       highlightonlymatchfilename = <bool> (default False)

       highlightonlymatchfilename will only highlight files if their type could be identified by their filename.
       When this is not enabled (the default), Pygments will try very  hard  to  identify  the  file  type  from
       content and any match (even matches with a low confidence score) will be used.

   histedit
       interactive history editing

       With  this  extension installed, Mercurial gains one new command: histedit. Usage is as follows, assuming
       the following history:

       @  3[tip]   7c2fd3b9020c   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add delta
       |
       o  2   030b686bedc4   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add gamma
       |
       o  1   c561b4e977df   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add beta
       |
       o  0   d8d2fcd0e319   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
            Add alpha

       If you were to run hg histedit c561b4e977df, you would see the following file open in your editor:

       pick c561b4e977df Add beta
       pick 030b686bedc4 Add gamma
       pick 7c2fd3b9020c Add delta

       # Edit history between c561b4e977df and 7c2fd3b9020c
       #
       # Commits are listed from least to most recent
       #
       # Commands:
       #  p, pick = use commit
       #  e, edit = use commit, but stop for amending
       #  f, fold = use commit, but combine it with the one above
       #  r, roll = like fold, but discard this commit's description and date
       #  d, drop = remove commit from history
       #  m, mess = edit commit message without changing commit content
       #  b, base = checkout changeset and apply further changesets from there
       #

       In this file, lines beginning with # are ignored. You must specify a  rule  for  each  revision  in  your
       history. For example, if you had meant to add gamma before beta, and then wanted to add delta in the same
       revision as beta, you would reorganize the file to look like this:

       pick 030b686bedc4 Add gamma
       pick c561b4e977df Add beta
       fold 7c2fd3b9020c Add delta

       # Edit history between c561b4e977df and 7c2fd3b9020c
       #
       # Commits are listed from least to most recent
       #
       # Commands:
       #  p, pick = use commit
       #  e, edit = use commit, but stop for amending
       #  f, fold = use commit, but combine it with the one above
       #  r, roll = like fold, but discard this commit's description and date
       #  d, drop = remove commit from history
       #  m, mess = edit commit message without changing commit content
       #  b, base = checkout changeset and apply further changesets from there
       #

       At which point you close the editor and histedit starts working.  When  you  specify  a  fold  operation,
       histedit  will  open  an editor when it folds those revisions together, offering you a chance to clean up
       the commit message:

       Add beta
       ***
       Add delta

       Edit the commit message to your liking, then close the editor. The date used for the commit will  be  the
       later  of  the  two commits' dates. For this example, let's assume that the commit message was changed to
       Add beta and delta.  After histedit has run and had a chance to remove any old or temporary revisions  it
       needed, the history looks like this:

       @  2[tip]   989b4d060121   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add beta and delta.
       |
       o  1   081603921c3f   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add gamma
       |
       o  0   d8d2fcd0e319   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
            Add alpha

       Note  that  histedit  does  not  remove  any  revisions  (even its own temporary ones) until after it has
       completed all the editing operations, so it will probably perform  several  strip  operations  when  it's
       done.  For  the  above  example,  it  had to run strip twice. Strip can be slow depending on a variety of
       factors, so you might need to be a little patient. You can choose  to  keep  the  original  revisions  by
       passing the --keep flag.

       The edit operation will drop you back to a command prompt, allowing you to edit files freely, or even use
       hg record to commit some changes as a separate  commit.  When  you're  done,  any  remaining  uncommitted
       changes  will  be  committed as well. When done, run hg histedit --continue to finish this step. If there
       are uncommitted changes, you'll be prompted for a new commit message, but the default commit message will
       be the original message for the edit ed revision, and the date of the original commit will be preserved.

       The  message  operation  will give you a chance to revise a commit message without changing the contents.
       It's a shortcut for doing edit immediately followed by hg histedit --continue`.

       If histedit encounters a conflict when moving a revision (while handling pick or fold), it'll stop  in  a
       similar  manner  to  edit with the difference that it won't prompt you for a commit message when done. If
       you decide at this point that you don't like how much work it will be to rearrange history, or  that  you
       made  a  mistake,  you can use hg histedit --abort to abandon the new changes you have made and return to
       the state before you attempted to edit your history.

       If we clone the histedit-ed example repository above and add four more changes, such  that  we  have  the
       following history:

       @  6[tip]   038383181893   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   stefan
       |    Add theta
       |
       o  5   140988835471   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   stefan
       |    Add eta
       |
       o  4   122930637314   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   stefan
       |    Add zeta
       |
       o  3   836302820282   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   stefan
       |    Add epsilon
       |
       o  2   989b4d060121   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add beta and delta.
       |
       o  1   081603921c3f   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
       |    Add gamma
       |
       o  0   d8d2fcd0e319   2009-04-27 18:04 -0500   durin42
            Add alpha

       If  you  run hg histedit --outgoing on the clone then it is the same as running hg histedit 836302820282.
       If you need plan to push to a repository that Mercurial does not detect to be related to the source repo,
       you can add a --force option.

   Config
       Histedit rule lines are truncated to 80 characters by default. You can customize this behavior by setting
       a different length in your configuration file:

       [histedit]
       linelen = 120      # truncate rule lines at 120 characters

       The summary of a change can be customized as well:

       [histedit]
       summary-template = '{rev} {bookmarks} {desc|firstline}'

       The customized summary should be kept short enough that rule  lines  will  fit  in  the  configured  line
       length. See above if that requires customization.

       hg  histedit  attempts  to automatically choose an appropriate base revision to use. To change which base
       revision is used, define a revset in your configuration file:

       [histedit]
       defaultrev = only(.) & draft()

       By default each edited revision needs to be present in histedit commands.  To remove revision you need to
       use drop operation. You can configure the drop to be implicit for missing commits by adding:

       [histedit]
       dropmissing = True

       By  default,  histedit  will  close  the transaction after each action. For performance purposes, you can
       configure histedit to use a  single  transaction  across  the  entire  histedit.  WARNING:  This  setting
       introduces  a  significant  risk  of  losing  the  work  you've done in a histedit if the histedit aborts
       unexpectedly:

       [histedit]
       singletransaction = True

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   histedit
       interactively edit changeset history:

       hg histedit [OPTIONS] ([ANCESTOR] | --outgoing [URL])

       This command lets you edit a linear series of changesets (up to  and  including  the  working  directory,
       which should be clean).  You can:

       • pick to [re]order a changeset

       • drop to omit changeset

       • mess to reword the changeset commit message

       • fold to combine it with the preceding changeset (using the later date)

       • roll like fold, but discarding this commit's description and date

       • edit to edit this changeset (preserving date)

       • base to checkout changeset and apply further changesets from there

       There are a number of ways to select the root changeset:

       • Specify ANCESTOR directly

       • Use  --outgoing  --  it  will  be  the first linear changeset not included in destination. (See hg help
         config.paths.default-push)

       • Otherwise, the value from the "histedit.defaultrev" config option is used as a  revset  to  select  the
         base  revision  when  ANCESTOR  is not specified. The first revision returned by the revset is used. By
         default, this selects the editable history that is unique to the ancestry of the working directory.

       If you use --outgoing, this command will abort if there are ambiguous outgoing revisions. For example, if
       there are multiple branches containing outgoing revisions.

       Use  "min(outgoing()  and  ::.)"  or  similar  revset specification instead of --outgoing to specify edit
       target revision exactly in such ambiguous situation. See  hg  help  revsets for  detail  about  selecting
       revisions.

       Examples:

          • A number of changes have been made.  Revision 3 is no longer needed.

            Start history editing from revision 3:

            hg histedit -r 3

            An editor opens, containing the list of revisions, with specific actions specified:

            pick 5339bf82f0ca 3 Zworgle the foobar
            pick 8ef592ce7cc4 4 Bedazzle the zerlog
            pick 0a9639fcda9d 5 Morgify the cromulancy

            Additional information about the possible actions to take appears below the list of revisions.

            To remove revision 3 from the history, its action (at the beginning of the relevant line) is changed
            to 'drop':

            drop 5339bf82f0ca 3 Zworgle the foobar
            pick 8ef592ce7cc4 4 Bedazzle the zerlog
            pick 0a9639fcda9d 5 Morgify the cromulancy

          • A number of changes have been made.  Revision 2 and 4 need to be swapped.

            Start history editing from revision 2:

            hg histedit -r 2

            An editor opens, containing the list of revisions, with specific actions specified:

            pick 252a1af424ad 2 Blorb a morgwazzle
            pick 5339bf82f0ca 3 Zworgle the foobar
            pick 8ef592ce7cc4 4 Bedazzle the zerlog

            To swap revision 2 and 4, its lines are swapped in the editor:

            pick 8ef592ce7cc4 4 Bedazzle the zerlog
            pick 5339bf82f0ca 3 Zworgle the foobar
            pick 252a1af424ad 2 Blorb a morgwazzle

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if user intervention is required (not only for intentional  "edit"  command,  but
       also for resolving unexpected conflicts).

       Options:

       --commands <FILE>
              read history edits from the specified file

       -c, --continue
              continue an edit already in progress

       --edit-plan
              edit remaining actions list

       -k, --keep
              don't strip old nodes after edit is complete

       --abort
              abort an edit in progress

       -o, --outgoing
              changesets not found in destination

       -f, --force
              force outgoing even for unrelated repositories

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              first revision to be edited

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   infinitepush
          store some pushes in a remote blob store on the server (EXPERIMENTAL)

       IMPORTANT:  if  you  use  this  extension,  please  contact  mercurial-devel@mercurial-scm.org ASAP. This
       extension is believed to be unused and barring learning of users of this functionality,  we  will  delete
       this code at the end of 2020.

          [infinitepush]   #   Server-side   and  client-side  option.  Pattern  of  the  infinitepush  bookmark
          branchpattern = PATTERN

          # Server or client server = False

          # Server-side option. Possible values: 'disk' or 'sql'. Fails if not set indextype = disk

          # Server-side option. Used only if indextype=sql.  # Format: 'IP:PORT:DB_NAME:USER:PASSWORD' sqlhost =
          IP:PORT:DB_NAME:USER:PASSWORD

          #  Server-side  option. Used only if indextype=disk.  # Filesystem path to the index store indexpath =
          PATH

          # Server-side option. Possible values: 'disk' or 'external' # Fails if not set storetype = disk

          # Server-side option.  # Path to the binary that will save bundle to the bundlestore #  Formatted  cmd
          line will be passed to it (see put_args) put_binary = put

          #  Serser-side  option.  Used  only  if  storetype=external.  # Format cmd-line string for put binary.
          Placeholder: {filename} put_args = {filename}

          # Server-side option.  # Path to the binary that get bundle from the  bundlestore.   #  Formatted  cmd
          line will be passed to it (see get_args) get_binary = get

          #  Serser-side  option.  Used  only  if  storetype=external.  # Format cmd-line string for get binary.
          Placeholders: {filename} {handle} get_args = {filename} {handle}

          # Server-side option logfile = FIlE

          # Server-side option loglevel = DEBUG

          # Server-side option. Used only if indextype=sql.  # Sets mysql wait_timeout  option.   waittimeout  =
          300

          #  Server-side  option.  Used  only  if  indextype=sql.  # Sets mysql innodb_lock_wait_timeout option.
          locktimeout = 120

          # Server-side option. Used only if indextype=sql.  # Name of the repository reponame = ''

          # Client-side option. Used by --list-remote option. List of remote scratch # patterns to  list  if  no
          patterns are specified.  defaultremotepatterns = ['*']

          #  Instructs  infinitepush to forward all received bundle2 parts to the # bundle for storage. Defaults
          to False.  storeallparts = True

          # routes each incoming push to the bundlestore. defaults to False pushtobundlestore = True

          [remotenames] # Client-side option # This option should  be  set  only  if  remotenames  extension  is
          enabled.  # Whether remote bookmarks are tracked by remotenames extension.  bookmarks = True

   journal
       track previous positions of bookmarks (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension adds a new command: hg journal, which shows you where bookmarks were previously located.

   Commands
   Change organization
   journal
       show the previous position of bookmarks and the working copy:

       hg journal [OPTION]... [BOOKMARKNAME]

       The  journal  is  used  to  see  the  previous commits that bookmarks and the working copy pointed to. By
       default the previous locations for the working copy.  Passing a bookmark name will show all the  previous
       positions  of  that  bookmark.  Use the --all switch to show previous locations for all bookmarks and the
       working copy; each line will then include the bookmark name, or '.' for the working copy, as well.

       If name starts with re:, the remainder of the name is treated as a regular expression. To  match  a  name
       that actually starts with re:, use the prefix literal:.

       By  default  hg  journal  only  shows  the  commit  hash  and  the command that was running at that time.
       -v/--verbose will show the prior hash, the user, and the time at which it happened.

       Use -c/--commits to output log information on each commit hash; at this  point  you  can  use  the  usual
       --patch, --git, --stat and --template switches to alter the log output for these.

       hg journal -T json can be used to produce machine readable output.

       Options:

       --all  show history for all names

       -c, --commits
              show commit metadata

       -p, --patch
              show patch

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -l,--limit <NUM>
              limit number of changes displayed

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       --style <STYLE>
              display using template map file (DEPRECATED)

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   keyword
       expand keywords in tracked files

       This  extension expands RCS/CVS-like or self-customized $Keywords$ in tracked text files selected by your
       configuration.

       Keywords are only expanded in local repositories and not stored in the change history. The mechanism  can
       be regarded as a convenience for the current user or for archive distribution.

       Keywords  expand  to the changeset data pertaining to the latest change relative to the working directory
       parent of each file.

       Configuration is done in the [keyword], [keywordset] and [keywordmaps] sections of hgrc files.

       Example:

       [keyword]
       # expand keywords in every python file except those matching "x*"
       **.py =
       x*    = ignore

       [keywordset]
       # prefer svn- over cvs-like default keywordmaps
       svn = True

       Note   The more specific you are in your filename patterns the less you lose speed in huge repositories.

       For [keywordmaps] template mapping and expansion demonstration and control run hg  kwdemo.  See  hg  help
       templates for a list of available templates and filters.

       Three additional date template filters are provided:

       utcdate

              "2006/09/18 15:13:13"

       svnutcdate

              "2006-09-18 15:13:13Z"

       svnisodate

              "2006-09-18 08:13:13 -700 (Mon, 18 Sep 2006)"

       The  default  template  mappings  (view  with  hg kwdemo -d) can be replaced with customized keywords and
       templates. Again, run hg kwdemo to control the results of your configuration changes.

       Before changing/disabling active keywords, you must run hg kwshrink to avoid storing expanded keywords in
       the change history.

       To force expansion after enabling it, or a configuration change, run hg kwexpand.

       Expansions  spanning more than one line and incremental expansions, like CVS' $Log$, are not supported. A
       keyword template map "Log = {desc}" expands to the first line of the changeset description.

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   kwdemo
       print [keywordmaps] configuration and an expansion example:

       hg kwdemo [-d] [-f RCFILE] [TEMPLATEMAP]...

       Show current, custom, or default keyword template maps and their expansions.

       Extend the current configuration by specifying maps as arguments  and  using  -f/--rcfile  to  source  an
       external hgrc file.

       Use -d/--default to disable current configuration.

       See hg help templates for information on templates and filters.

       Options:

       -d, --default
              show default keyword template maps

       -f,--rcfile <FILE>
              read maps from rcfile

   kwexpand
       expand keywords in the working directory:

       hg kwexpand [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Run after (re)enabling keyword expansion.

       kwexpand refuses to run if given files contain local changes.

       Options:

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   kwfiles
       show files configured for keyword expansion:

       hg kwfiles [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       List which files in the working directory are matched by the [keyword] configuration patterns.

       Useful  to  prevent  inadvertent keyword expansion and to speed up execution by including only files that
       are actual candidates for expansion.

       See hg help keyword on how to construct patterns both for inclusion and exclusion of files.

       With -A/--all and -v/--verbose the codes used to show the status of files are:

       K = keyword expansion candidate
       k = keyword expansion candidate (not tracked)
       I = ignored
       i = ignored (not tracked)

       Options:

       -A, --all
              show keyword status flags of all files

       -i, --ignore
              show files excluded from expansion

       -u, --unknown
              only show unknown (not tracked) files

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   kwshrink
       revert expanded keywords in the working directory:

       hg kwshrink [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Must be run before changing/disabling active keywords.

       kwshrink refuses to run if given files contain local changes.

       Options:

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   largefiles
       track large binary files

       Large binary files tend to be not very compressible, not very diffable, and not at  all  mergeable.  Such
       files  are  not  handled efficiently by Mercurial's storage format (revlog), which is based on compressed
       binary deltas; storing large binary files as regular Mercurial files wastes bandwidth and disk space  and
       increases  Mercurial's  memory  usage.  The  largefiles  extension  addresses  these problems by adding a
       centralized client-server layer on top of Mercurial: largefiles live  in  a  central  store  out  on  the
       network somewhere, and you only fetch the revisions that you need when you need them.

       largefiles works by maintaining a "standin file" in .hglf/ for each largefile. The standins are small (41
       bytes: an SHA-1 hash plus newline) and are tracked by Mercurial. Largefile revisions  are  identified  by
       the  SHA-1  hash  of their contents, which is written to the standin. largefiles uses that revision ID to
       get/put largefile revisions from/to the central store. This saves both disk space  and  bandwidth,  since
       you don't need to retrieve all historical revisions of large files when you clone or pull.

       To  start  a  new  repository or add new large binary files, just add --large to your hg add command. For
       example:

       $ dd if=/dev/urandom of=randomdata count=2000
       $ hg add --large randomdata
       $ hg commit -m "add randomdata as a largefile"

       When you push a changeset that adds/modifies largefiles to a remote repository, its  largefile  revisions
       will  be  uploaded along with it.  Note that the remote Mercurial must also have the largefiles extension
       enabled for this to work.

       When you pull a changeset that affects largefiles from  a  remote  repository,  the  largefiles  for  the
       changeset will by default not be pulled down. However, when you update to such a revision, any largefiles
       needed by that revision are downloaded and cached (if they have never been downloaded before). One way to
       pull  largefiles  when pulling is thus to use --update, which will update your working copy to the latest
       pulled revision (and thereby downloading any new largefiles).

       If you want to pull largefiles you don't need for update yet, then you can  use  pull  with  the  --lfrev
       option or the hg lfpull command.

       If  you  know  you  are  pulling from a non-default location and want to download all the largefiles that
       correspond to the new changesets at the same time, then you can pull with --lfrev "pulled()".

       If you just want to ensure that you will have the largefiles needed to merge or  rebase  with  new  heads
       that  you are pulling, then you can pull with --lfrev "head(pulled())" flag to pre-emptively download any
       largefiles that are new in the heads you are pulling.

       Keep in mind that network access may now be required to update to changesets that you have not previously
       updated  to.  The  nature of the largefiles extension means that updating is no longer guaranteed to be a
       local-only operation.

       If you already have large files tracked by Mercurial without the largefiles extension, you will  need  to
       convert your repository in order to benefit from largefiles. This is done with the hg lfconvert command:

       $ hg lfconvert --size 10 oldrepo newrepo

       In  repositories that already have largefiles in them, any new file over 10MB will automatically be added
       as a largefile. To change this threshold, set largefiles.minsize in your Mercurial  config  file  to  the
       minimum size in megabytes to track as a largefile, or use the --lfsize option to the add command (also in
       megabytes):

       [largefiles]
       minsize = 2

       $ hg add --lfsize 2

       The largefiles.patterns config option allows you to specify a list of  filename  patterns  (see  hg  help
       patterns) that should always be tracked as largefiles:

       [largefiles]
       patterns =
         *.jpg
         re:.*\.(png|bmp)$
         library.zip
         content/audio/*

       Files that match one of these patterns will be added as largefiles regardless of their size.

       The  largefiles.minsize  and  largefiles.patterns config options will be ignored for any repositories not
       already containing a largefile. To add the first largefile to a repository, you  must  explicitly  do  so
       with the --large flag passed to the hg add command.

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   lfconvert
       convert a normal repository to a largefiles repository:

       hg lfconvert SOURCE DEST [FILE ...]

       Convert repository SOURCE to a new repository DEST, identical to SOURCE except that certain files will be
       converted as largefiles: specifically, any file that matches any PATTERN  or  whose  size  is  above  the
       minimum  size threshold is converted as a largefile. The size used to determine whether or not to track a
       file as a largefile is the size of the first version of the file.  The  minimum  size  can  be  specified
       either with --size or in configuration as largefiles.size.

       After  running  this command you will need to make sure that largefiles is enabled anywhere you intend to
       push the new repository.

       Use --to-normal to convert largefiles back to normal files; after this, the DEST repository can  be  used
       without largefiles at all.

       Options:

       -s,--size <SIZE>
              minimum size (MB) for files to be converted as largefiles

       --to-normal
              convert from a largefiles repo to a normal repo

   lfpull
       pull largefiles for the specified revisions from the specified source:

       hg lfpull -r REV... [-e CMD] [--remotecmd CMD] [SOURCE]

       Pull  largefiles  that  are  referenced  from local changesets but missing locally, pulling from a remote
       repository to the local cache.

       If SOURCE is omitted, the 'default' path will be used.  See hg help urls for more information.

       Some examples:

       • pull largefiles for all branch heads:

         hg lfpull -r "head() and not closed()"

       • pull largefiles on the default branch:

         hg lfpull -r "branch(default)"

       Options:

       -r,--rev <VALUE[+]>
              pull largefiles for these revisions

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   lfs
       lfs - large file support (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension allows large files to be tracked outside of the normal repository storage and stored on  a
       centralized server, similar to the largefiles extension.  The git-lfs protocol is used when communicating
       with the server, so existing git infrastructure can be harnessed.   Even  though  the  files  are  stored
       outside of the repository, they are still integrity checked in the same manner as normal files.

       The files stored outside of the repository are downloaded on demand, which reduces the time to clone, and
       possibly the local disk usage.  This changes fundamental workflows in a DVCS, so careful  thought  should
       be  given before deploying it.  hg convert can be used to convert LFS repositories to normal repositories
       that no longer require this extension, and do so without changing the commit  hashes.   This  allows  the
       extension  to  be  disabled  if  the  centralized workflow becomes burdensome.  However, the pre and post
       convert clones will not be able to communicate with each other unless the extension is enabled on both.

       To start a new repository, or to add LFS files to  an  existing  one,  just  create  an  .hglfs  file  as
       described  below  in  the  root  directory  of  the repository.  Typically, this file should be put under
       version control, so that the settings will propagate to other repositories with push  and  pull.   During
       any  commit,  Mercurial will consult this file to determine if an added or modified file should be stored
       externally.  The type of storage depends on the characteristics of the file at each commit.  A file  that
       is near a size threshold may switch back and forth between LFS and normal storage, as needed.

       Alternately,  both  normal  repositories and largefile controlled repositories can be converted to LFS by
       using hg convert and the lfs.track config option described below.  The .hglfs file should then be created
       and added, to control subsequent LFS selection.  The hashes are also unchanged in this case.  The LFS and
       non-LFS repositories can be distinguished because the LFS repository  will  abort  any  command  if  this
       extension is disabled.

       Committed  LFS  files  are  held  locally,  until  the repository is pushed.  Prior to pushing the normal
       repository data, the LFS files that are tracked by the outgoing commits are automatically uploaded to the
       configured  central server.  No LFS files are transferred on hg pull or hg clone.  Instead, the files are
       downloaded on demand as they need to be read, if a cached copy cannot be found locally.  Both  committing
       and  downloading  an  LFS  file  will  link  the file to a usercache, to speed up future access.  See the
       usercache config setting described below.

       The extension reads its configuration from a versioned .hglfs configuration file found in the root of the
       working  directory.  The  .hglfs file uses the same syntax as all other Mercurial configuration files. It
       uses a single section, [track].

       The [track] section specifies which files are stored as LFS (or not).  Each  line  is  keyed  by  a  file
       pattern,  with  a  predicate  value.  The first file pattern match is used, so put more specific patterns
       first.  The available predicates are all(), none(), and size().  See  "hg  help  filesets.size"  for  the
       latter.

       Example versioned .hglfs file:

       [track]
       # No Makefile or python file, anywhere, will be LFS
       **Makefile = none()
       **.py = none()

       **.zip = all()
       **.exe = size(">1MB")

       # Catchall for everything not matched above
       ** = size(">10MB")

       Configs:

       [lfs]
       # Remote endpoint. Multiple protocols are supported:
       # - http(s)://user:pass@example.com/path
       #   git-lfs endpoint
       # - file:///tmp/path
       #   local filesystem, usually for testing
       # if unset, lfs will assume the remote repository also handles blob storage
       # for http(s) URLs.  Otherwise, lfs will prompt to set this when it must
       # use this value.
       # (default: unset)
       url = https://example.com/repo.git/info/lfs

       # Which files to track in LFS.  Path tests are "**.extname" for file
       # extensions, and "path:under/some/directory" for path prefix.  Both
       # are relative to the repository root.
       # File size can be tested with the "size()" fileset, and tests can be
       # joined with fileset operators.  (See "hg help filesets.operators".)
       #
       # Some examples:
       # - all()                       # everything
       # - none()                      # nothing
       # - size(">20MB")               # larger than 20MB
       # - !**.txt                     # anything not a *.txt file
       # - **.zip | **.tar.gz | **.7z  # some types of compressed files
       # - path:bin                    # files under "bin" in the project root
       # - (**.php & size(">2MB")) | (**.js & size(">5MB")) | **.tar.gz
       #     | (path:bin & !path:/bin/README) | size(">1GB")
       # (default: none())
       #
       # This is ignored if there is a tracked '.hglfs' file, and this setting
       # will eventually be deprecated and removed.
       track = size(">10M")

       # how many times to retry before giving up on transferring an object
       retry = 5

       # the local directory to store lfs files for sharing across local clones.
       # If not set, the cache is located in an OS specific cache location.
       usercache = /path/to/global/cache

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   logtoprocess
       send ui.log() data to a subprocess (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension lets you specify a shell command per ui.log() event, sending all remaining arguments to as
       environment variables to that command.

       Positional arguments construct a log message, which is passed in the  MSG1  environment  variables.  Each
       keyword  argument  is  set  as  a OPT_UPPERCASE_KEY variable (so the key is uppercased, and prefixed with
       OPT_). The original event name is passed in the  EVENT  environment  variable,  and  the  process  ID  of
       mercurial is given in HGPID.

       So  given a call ui.log('foo', 'bar %s ', 'baz', spam='eggs'), a script configured for the `foo event can
       expect an environment with MSG1=bar baz, and OPT_SPAM=eggs.

       Scripts are configured in the [logtoprocess] section, each key an event name.  For example:

       [logtoprocess]
       commandexception = echo "$MSG1" > /var/log/mercurial_exceptions.log

       would log the warning message and traceback of any failed command dispatch.

       Scripts are run asynchronously as detached daemon processes; mercurial will not  ensure  that  they  exit
       cleanly.

   mq
       manage a stack of patches

       This  extension lets you work with a stack of patches in a Mercurial repository. It manages two stacks of
       patches - all known patches, and applied patches (subset of known patches).

       Known patches are represented as patch files in the .hg/patches directory. Applied patches are both patch
       files and changesets.

       Common tasks (use hg help COMMAND for more details):

       create new patch                          qnew
       import existing patch                     qimport

       print patch series                        qseries
       print applied patches                     qapplied

       add known patch to applied stack          qpush
       remove patch from applied stack           qpop
       refresh contents of top applied patch     qrefresh

       By  default,  mq will automatically use git patches when required to avoid losing file mode changes, copy
       records, binary files or empty files creations or deletions. This behavior can be configured with:

       [mq]
       git = auto/keep/yes/no

       If set to 'keep', mq will obey the [diff] section configuration while  preserving  existing  git  patches
       upon  qrefresh.  If  set to 'yes' or 'no', mq will override the [diff] section and always generate git or
       regular patches, possibly losing data in the second case.

       It may be desirable for mq changesets to be kept in the secret phase (see hg help phases), which  can  be
       enabled with the following setting:

       [mq]
       secret = True

       You  will  by  default be managing a patch queue named "patches". You can create other, independent patch
       queues with the hg qqueue command.

       If the working directory contains  uncommitted  files,  qpush,  qpop  and  qgoto  abort  immediately.  If
       -f/--force is used, the changes are discarded. Setting:

       [mq]
       keepchanges = True

       make  them  behave  as if --keep-changes were passed, and non-conflicting local changes will be tolerated
       and preserved. If incompatible options such as -f/--force or --exact are passed, this setting is ignored.

       This extension used to provide a strip command. This command now lives in the strip extension.

   Commands
   Repository creation
   qclone
       clone main and patch repository at same time:

       hg qclone [OPTION]... SOURCE [DEST]

       If source is local, destination will have no patches applied. If source is remote, this command  can  not
       check  if patches are applied in source, so cannot guarantee that patches are not applied in destination.
       If you clone remote repository, be sure before that it has no patches applied.

       Source patch repository is looked for in <src>/.hg/patches by default. Use -p <url> to change.

       The patch directory must be a nested Mercurial repository, as would be created by hg init --mq.

       Return 0 on success.

       Options:

       --pull use pull protocol to copy metadata

       -U, --noupdate
              do not update the new working directories

       --uncompressed
              use uncompressed transfer (fast over LAN)

       -p,--patches <REPO>
              location of source patch repository

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

   qinit
       init a new queue repository (DEPRECATED):

       hg qinit [-c]

       The queue repository is unversioned by default. If -c/--create-repo is specified,  qinit  will  create  a
       separate  nested  repository  for patches (qinit -c may also be run later to convert an unversioned patch
       repository into a versioned one). You can use qcommit to commit changes to this queue repository.

       This command is deprecated. Without -c, it's implied by other relevant commands. With  -c,  use  hg  init
       --mq instead.

       Options:

       -c, --create-repo
              create queue repository

   Change creation
   qcommit
       commit changes in the queue repository (DEPRECATED):

       hg qcommit [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       This command is deprecated; use hg commit --mq instead.

       Options:

       -A, --addremove
              mark new/missing files as added/removed before committing

       --close-branch
              mark a branch head as closed

       --amend
              amend the parent of the working directory

       -s, --secret
              use the secret phase for committing

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       --force-close-branch
              forcibly close branch from a non-head changeset (ADVANCED)

       -i, --interactive
              use interactive mode

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: qci

   qnew
       create a new patch:

       hg qnew [-e] [-m TEXT] [-l FILE] PATCH [FILE]...

       qnew  creates  a  new patch on top of the currently-applied patch (if any). The patch will be initialized
       with any outstanding changes in the working directory.  You  may  also  use  -I/--include,  -X/--exclude,
       and/or  a  list  of  files  after  the patch name to add only changes to matching files to the new patch,
       leaving the rest as uncommitted modifications.

       -u/--user and -d/--date can be used to set the (given) user and date, respectively. -U/--currentuser  and
       -D/--currentdate set user to current user and date to current date.

       -e/--edit,  -m/--message  or  -l/--logfile set the patch header as well as the commit message. If none is
       specified, the header is empty and the commit message is '[mq]: PATCH'.

       Use the -g/--git option to keep the patch in the git extended diff format. Read the diffs help topic  for
       more information on why this is important for preserving permission changes and copy/rename information.

       Returns 0 on successful creation of a new patch.

       Options:

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -f, --force
              import uncommitted changes (DEPRECATED)

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -U, --currentuser
              add "From: <current user>" to patch

       -u,--user <USER>
              add "From: <USER>" to patch

       -D, --currentdate
              add "Date: <current date>" to patch

       -d,--date <DATE>
              add "Date: <DATE>" to patch

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   qrefresh
       update the current patch:

       hg qrefresh [-I] [-X] [-e] [-m TEXT] [-l FILE] [-s] [FILE]...

       If  any  file  patterns  are provided, the refreshed patch will contain only the modifications that match
       those patterns; the remaining modifications will remain in the working directory.

       If -s/--short is specified, files currently included in the patch will be  refreshed  just  like  matched
       files and remain in the patch.

       If  -e/--edit  is  specified,  Mercurial will start your configured editor for you to enter a message. In
       case qrefresh fails, you will find a backup of your message in .hg/last-message.txt.

       hg add/remove/copy/rename work as usual, though you might want to  use  git-style  patches  (-g/--git  or
       [diff]  git=1) to track copies and renames. See the diffs help topic for more information on the git diff
       format.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -s, --short
              refresh only files already in the patch and specified files

       -U, --currentuser
              add/update author field in patch with current user

       -u,--user <USER>
              add/update author field in patch with given user

       -D, --currentdate
              add/update date field in patch with current date

       -d,--date <DATE>
              add/update date field in patch with given date

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   Change manipulation
   qfold
       fold the named patches into the current patch:

       hg qfold [-e] [-k] [-m TEXT] [-l FILE] PATCH...

       Patches must not yet be applied. Each patch will be successively applied to  the  current  patch  in  the
       order  given.  If  all  the  patches apply successfully, the current patch will be refreshed with the new
       cumulative patch, and the folded patches will be deleted. With -k/--keep, the folded patch files will not
       be removed afterwards.

       The  header for each folded patch will be concatenated with the current patch header, separated by a line
       of * * *.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -k, --keep
              keep folded patch files

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

   Change organization
   qapplied
       print the patches already applied:

       hg qapplied [-1] [-s] [PATCH]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -1, --last
              show only the preceding applied patch

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   qdelete
       remove patches from queue:

       hg qdelete [-k] [PATCH]...

       The patches must not be applied, and at least one patch is required.  Exact  patch  identifiers  must  be
       given. With -k/--keep, the patch files are preserved in the patch directory.

       To stop managing a patch and move it into permanent history, use the hg qfinish command.

       Options:

       -k, --keep
              keep patch file

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              stop managing a revision (DEPRECATED)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: qremove qrm

   qfinish
       move applied patches into repository history:

       hg qfinish [-a] [REV]...

       Finishes the specified revisions (corresponding to applied patches) by moving them out of mq control into
       regular repository history.

       Accepts a revision range or the -a/--applied option. If --applied is specified, all applied mq  revisions
       are  removed  from mq control. Otherwise, the given revisions must be at the base of the stack of applied
       patches.

       This can be especially useful if your changes have been applied to an upstream repository, or if you  are
       about to push your changes to upstream.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -a, --applied
              finish all applied changesets

   qgoto
       push or pop patches until named patch is at top of stack:

       hg qgoto [OPTION]... PATCH

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       --keep-changes
              tolerate non-conflicting local changes

       -f, --force
              overwrite any local changes

       --no-backup
              do not save backup copies of files

   qguard
       set or print guards for a patch:

       hg qguard [-l] [-n] [PATCH] [-- [+GUARD]... [-GUARD]...]

       Guards  control  whether  a  patch can be pushed. A patch with no guards is always pushed. A patch with a
       positive guard ("+foo") is pushed only if the hg  qselect command  has  activated  it.  A  patch  with  a
       negative guard ("-foo") is never pushed if the hg qselect command has activated it.

       With no arguments, print the currently active guards.  With arguments, set guards for the named patch.

       Note   Specifying negative guards now requires '--'.

       To set guards on another patch:

       hg qguard other.patch -- +2.6.17 -stable

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -l, --list
              list all patches and guards

       -n, --none
              drop all guards

   qheader
       print the header of the topmost or specified patch:

       hg qheader [PATCH]

       Returns 0 on success.

   qnext
       print the name of the next pushable patch:

       hg qnext [-s]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   qpop
       pop the current patch off the stack:

       hg qpop [-a] [-f] [PATCH | INDEX]

       Without  argument,  pops off the top of the patch stack. If given a patch name, keeps popping off patches
       until the named patch is at the top of the stack.

       By default, abort if the working directory contains uncommitted changes. With --keep-changes, abort  only
       if  the uncommitted files overlap with patched files. With -f/--force, backup and discard changes made to
       such files.

       Return 0 on success.

       Options:

       -a, --all
              pop all patches

       -n,--name <NAME>
              queue name to pop (DEPRECATED)

       --keep-changes
              tolerate non-conflicting local changes

       -f, --force
              forget any local changes to patched files

       --no-backup
              do not save backup copies of files

   qprev
       print the name of the preceding applied patch:

       hg qprev [-s]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   qpush
       push the next patch onto the stack:

       hg qpush [-f] [-l] [-a] [--move] [PATCH | INDEX]

       By default, abort if the working directory contains uncommitted changes. With --keep-changes, abort  only
       if  the  uncommitted files overlap with patched files. With -f/--force, backup and patch over uncommitted
       changes.

       Return 0 on success.

       Options:

       --keep-changes
              tolerate non-conflicting local changes

       -f, --force
              apply on top of local changes

       -e, --exact
              apply the target patch to its recorded parent

       -l, --list
              list patch name in commit text

       -a, --all
              apply all patches

       -m, --merge
              merge from another queue (DEPRECATED)

       -n,--name <NAME>
              merge queue name (DEPRECATED)

       --move reorder patch series and apply only the patch

       --no-backup
              do not save backup copies of files

   qqueue
       manage multiple patch queues:

       hg qqueue [OPTION] [QUEUE]

       Supports switching between different patch queues, as well as creating  new  patch  queues  and  deleting
       existing ones.

       Omitting  a  queue  name  or  specifying  -l/--list  will show you the registered queues - by default the
       "normal" patches queue is registered.  The  currently  active  queue  will  be  marked  with  "(active)".
       Specifying --active will print only the name of the active queue.

       To  create a new queue, use -c/--create. The queue is automatically made active, except in the case where
       there are applied patches from the currently active queue in the repository. Then the queue will only  be
       created and switching will fail.

       To delete an existing queue, use --delete. You cannot delete the currently active queue.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -l, --list
              list all available queues

       --active
              print name of active queue

       -c, --create
              create new queue

       --rename
              rename active queue

       --delete
              delete reference to queue

       --purge
              delete queue, and remove patch dir

   qrename
       rename a patch:

       hg qrename PATCH1 [PATCH2]

       With one argument, renames the current patch to PATCH1.  With two arguments, renames PATCH1 to PATCH2.

       Returns 0 on success.

          aliases: qmv

   qrestore
       restore the queue state saved by a revision (DEPRECATED):

       hg qrestore [-d] [-u] REV

       This command is deprecated, use hg rebase instead.

       Options:

       -d, --delete
              delete save entry

       -u, --update
              update queue working directory

   qsave
       save current queue state (DEPRECATED):

       hg qsave [-m TEXT] [-l FILE] [-c] [-n NAME] [-e] [-f]

       This command is deprecated, use hg rebase instead.

       Options:

       -c, --copy
              copy patch directory

       -n,--name <NAME>
              copy directory name

       -e, --empty
              clear queue status file

       -f, --force
              force copy

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

   qselect
       set or print guarded patches to push:

       hg qselect [OPTION]... [GUARD]...

       Use  the  hg  qguard command to set or print guards on patch, then use qselect to tell mq which guards to
       use. A patch will be pushed if it has no guards or any  positive  guards  match  the  currently  selected
       guard, but will not be pushed if any negative guards match the current guard. For example:

       qguard foo.patch -- -stable    (negative guard)
       qguard bar.patch    +stable    (positive guard)
       qselect stable

       This  activates  the  "stable"  guard.  mq will skip foo.patch (because it has a negative match) but push
       bar.patch (because it has a positive match).

       With no arguments, prints the currently active guards.  With one argument, sets the active guard.

       Use -n/--none to deactivate guards (no other arguments needed).  When no guards are active, patches  with
       positive guards are skipped and patches with negative guards are pushed.

       qselect  can  change the guards on applied patches. It does not pop guarded patches by default. Use --pop
       to pop back to the last applied patch that is not guarded. Use --reapply (which implies  --pop)  to  push
       back to the current patch afterwards, but skip guarded patches.

       Use  -s/--series to print a list of all guards in the series file (no other arguments needed). Use -v for
       more information.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -n, --none
              disable all guards

       -s, --series
              list all guards in series file

       --pop  pop to before first guarded applied patch

       --reapply
              pop, then reapply patches

   qseries
       print the entire series file:

       hg qseries [-ms]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -m, --missing
              print patches not in series

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   qtop
       print the name of the current patch:

       hg qtop [-s]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   qunapplied
       print the patches not yet applied:

       hg qunapplied [-1] [-s] [PATCH]

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -1, --first
              show only the first patch

       -s, --summary
              print first line of patch header

   File content management
   qdiff
       diff of the current patch and subsequent modifications:

       hg qdiff [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       Shows a diff which includes the current patch as well as any changes which have been made in the  working
       directory since the last refresh (thus showing what the current patch would become after a qrefresh).

       Use  hg  diff if  you only want to see the changes made since the last qrefresh, or hg export qtip if you
       want to see changes made by the current patch without including changes made since the qrefresh.

       Returns 0 on success.

       Options:

       -a, --text
              treat all files as text

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       --binary
              generate binary diffs in git mode (default)

       --nodates
              omit dates from diff headers

       --noprefix
              omit a/ and b/ prefixes from filenames

       -p, --show-function
              show which function each change is in

       --reverse
              produce a diff that undoes the changes

       -w, --ignore-all-space
              ignore white space when comparing lines

       -b, --ignore-space-change
              ignore changes in the amount of white space

       -B, --ignore-blank-lines
              ignore changes whose lines are all blank

       -Z, --ignore-space-at-eol
              ignore changes in whitespace at EOL

       -U,--unified <NUM>
              number of lines of context to show

       --stat output diffstat-style summary of changes

       --root <DIR>
              produce diffs relative to subdirectory

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   Change import/export
   qimport
       import a patch or existing changeset:

       hg qimport [-e] [-n NAME] [-f] [-g] [-P] [-r REV]... [FILE]...

       The patch is inserted into the series after the last applied patch. If  no  patches  have  been  applied,
       qimport prepends the patch to the series.

       The patch will have the same name as its source file unless you give it a new one with -n/--name.

       You can register an existing patch inside the patch directory with the -e/--existing flag.

       With -f/--force, an existing patch of the same name will be overwritten.

       An  existing  changeset  may be placed under mq control with -r/--rev (e.g. qimport --rev . -n patch will
       place the current revision under mq control). With -g/--git, patches imported with --rev will use the git
       diff format. See the diffs help topic for information on why this is important for preserving rename/copy
       information and permission changes. Use hg qfinish to remove changesets from mq control.

       To import a patch from standard input, pass - as the patch file.  When importing from standard  input,  a
       patch name must be specified using the --name flag.

       To import an existing patch while renaming it:

       hg qimport -e existing-patch -n new-name

       Returns 0 if import succeeded.

       Options:

       -e, --existing
              import file in patch directory

       -n,--name <NAME>
              name of patch file

       -f, --force
              overwrite existing files

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              place existing revisions under mq control

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       -P, --push
              qpush after importing

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   narrow
       create clones which fetch history data for subset of files (EXPERIMENTAL)

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   tracked
       show or change the current narrowspec:

       hg tracked [OPTIONS]... [REMOTE]

       With no argument, shows the current narrowspec entries, one per line. Each line will be prefixed with 'I'
       or 'X' for included or excluded patterns, respectively.

       The narrowspec is comprised of expressions to match remote files and/or directories that should be pulled
       into  your  client.   The  narrowspec  has include and exclude expressions, with excludes always trumping
       includes: that is, if a file matches an exclude expression, it will be excluded even if it  also  matches
       an include expression.  Excluding files that were never included has no effect.

       Each included or excluded entry is in the format described by 'hg help patterns'.

       The options allow you to add or remove included and excluded expressions.

       If --clear is specified, then all previous includes and excludes are DROPPED and replaced by the new ones
       specified to --addinclude and --addexclude.  If --clear is specified without  any  further  options,  the
       narrowspec will be empty and will not match any files.

       If  --auto-remove-includes  is  specified,  then  those  includes  that don't match any files modified by
       currently visible local commits (those not shared by the remote) will be added to the set  of  explicitly
       specified includes to remove.

       --import-rules  accepts a path to a file containing rules, allowing you to add --addinclude, --addexclude
       rules in bulk. Like the other include and exclude switches, the changes are applied immediately.

       Options:

       --addinclude <VALUE[+]>
              new paths to include

       --removeinclude <VALUE[+]>
              old paths to no longer include

       --auto-remove-includes
              automatically choose unused includes to remove

       --addexclude <VALUE[+]>
              new paths to exclude

       --import-rules <VALUE>
              import narrowspecs from a file

       --removeexclude <VALUE[+]>
              old paths to no longer exclude

       --clear
              whether to replace the existing narrowspec

       --force-delete-local-changes
              forces deletion of local changes when narrowing

       --update-working-copy
              update working copy when the store has changed

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   notify
       hooks for sending email push notifications

       This extension implements hooks to send email notifications when changesets are sent from or received  by
       the local repository.

       First,  enable  the  extension as explained in hg help extensions, and register the hook you want to run.
       incoming and changegroup hooks are run when  changesets  are  received,  while  outgoing  hooks  are  for
       changesets sent to another repository:

       [hooks]
       # one email for each incoming changeset
       incoming.notify = python:hgext.notify.hook
       # one email for all incoming changesets
       changegroup.notify = python:hgext.notify.hook

       # one email for all outgoing changesets
       outgoing.notify = python:hgext.notify.hook

       This  registers  the  hooks.  To  enable  notification, subscribers must be assigned to repositories. The
       [usersubs] section maps multiple repositories to a given recipient. The [reposubs] section maps  multiple
       recipients to a single repository:

       [usersubs]
       # key is subscriber email, value is a comma-separated list of repo patterns
       user@host = pattern

       [reposubs]
       # key is repo pattern, value is a comma-separated list of subscriber emails
       pattern = user@host

       A  pattern  is  a  glob  matching  the  absolute  path to a repository, optionally combined with a revset
       expression. A revset expression, if present, is separated from the glob by a hash. Example:

       [reposubs]
       */widgets#branch(release) = qa-team@example.com

       This sends to qa-team@example.com whenever a changeset on the release branch triggers a  notification  in
       any repository ending in widgets.

       In  order to place them under direct user management, [usersubs] and [reposubs] sections may be placed in
       a separate hgrc file and incorporated by reference:

       [notify]
       config = /path/to/subscriptionsfile

       Notifications will not be sent until the notify.test value is set to False; see below.

       Notifications content can be tweaked with the following configuration entries:

       notify.test
              If True, print messages to stdout instead of sending them. Default: True.

       notify.sources
              Space-separated list of change sources. Notifications are activated only when a changeset's source
              is in this list. Sources may be:

              serve

                     changesets received via http or ssh

              pull

                     changesets received via hg pull

              unbundle

                     changesets received via hg unbundle

              push

                     changesets sent or received via hg push

              bundle

                     changesets sent via hg unbundle

              Default: serve.

       notify.strip
              Number  of  leading  slashes  to  strip  from  url  paths.  By  default,  notifications  reference
              repositories with their absolute path. notify.strip lets you turn them into  relative  paths.  For
              example, notify.strip=3 will change /long/path/repository into repository. Default: 0.

       notify.domain
              Default  email  domain  for sender or recipients with no explicit domain.  It is also used for the
              domain part of the Message-Id when using notify.messageidseed.

       notify.messageidseed
              Create deterministic Message-Id headers  for  the  mails  based  on  the  seed  and  the  revision
              identifier of the first commit in the changeset.

       notify.style
              Style file to use when formatting emails.

       notify.template
              Template to use when formatting emails.

       notify.incoming
              Template to use when run as an incoming hook, overriding notify.template.

       notify.outgoing
              Template to use when run as an outgoing hook, overriding notify.template.

       notify.changegroup
              Template to use when running as a changegroup hook, overriding notify.template.

       notify.maxdiff
              Maximum number of diff lines to include in notification email. Set to 0 to disable the diff, or -1
              to include all of it. Default: 300.

       notify.maxdiffstat
              Maximum number of diffstat lines to include in notification email. Set to -1 to include all of it.
              Default: -1.

       notify.maxsubject
              Maximum number of characters in email's subject line. Default: 67.

       notify.diffstat
              Set to True to include a diffstat before diff content. Default: True.

       notify.showfunc
              If set, override diff.showfunc for the diff content. Default: None.

       notify.merge
              If True, send notifications for merge changesets. Default: True.

       notify.mbox
              If set, append mails to this mbox file instead of sending. Default: None.

       notify.fromauthor
              If  set,  use  the  committer  of the first changeset in a changegroup for the "From" field of the
              notification mail. If not set, take the user from the pushing repo.  Default: False.

       If set, the following entries will also be used to customize the notifications:

       email.from
              Email From address to use if none can be found in the generated email content.

       web.baseurl
              Root  repository  URL  to  combine  with  repository  paths  when  making  references.  See   also
              notify.strip.

   pager
       browse command output with an external pager (DEPRECATED)

       Forcibly  enable  paging  for  individual  commands  that  don't  typically  request  pagination with the
       attend-<command> option. This setting takes precedence over ignore options and defaults:

       [pager]
       attend-cat = false

   patchbomb
       command to send changesets as (a series of) patch emails

       The series is started off with a "[PATCH 0 of N]" introduction, which describes the series as a whole.

       Each patch email has a Subject line of "[PATCH M of N] ...",  using  the  first  line  of  the  changeset
       description as the subject text. The message contains two or three body parts:

       • The changeset description.

       • [Optional] The result of running diffstat on the patch.

       • The patch itself, as generated by hg export.

       Each message refers to the first in the series using the In-Reply-To and References headers, so they will
       show up as a sequence in threaded mail and news readers, and in mail archives.

       To configure other defaults, add a section like this to your configuration file:

       [email]
       from = My Name <my@email>
       to = recipient1, recipient2, ...
       cc = cc1, cc2, ...
       bcc = bcc1, bcc2, ...
       reply-to = address1, address2, ...

       Use [patchbomb] as configuration section name if you need to override global [email] address settings.

       Then you can use the hg email command to mail a series of changesets as a patchbomb.

       You can also either configure the method option in the email section to be a sendmail  compatible  mailer
       or fill out the [smtp] section so that the patchbomb extension can automatically send patchbombs directly
       from the commandline. See the [email] and [smtp] sections in hgrc(5) for details.

       By default, hg email will prompt for a To or CC header if you do not supply one via configuration or  the
       command line.  You can override this to never prompt by configuring an empty value:

       [email]
       cc =

       You  can  control the default inclusion of an introduction message with the patchbomb.intro configuration
       option. The configuration is always overwritten by command line flags like --intro and --desc:

       [patchbomb]
       intro=auto   # include introduction message if more than 1 patch (default)
       intro=never  # never include an introduction message
       intro=always # always include an introduction message

       You can specify a template for flags to be added in subject prefixes. Flags specified  by  --flag  option
       are exported as {flags} keyword:

       [patchbomb]
       flagtemplate = "{separate(' ',
                                 ifeq(branch, 'default', '', branch|upper),
                                 flags)}"

       You can set patchbomb to always ask for confirmation by setting patchbomb.confirm to true.

   Commands
   Change import/export
   email
       send changesets by email:

       hg email [OPTION]... [DEST]...

       By  default, diffs are sent in the format generated by hg export, one per message. The series starts with
       a "[PATCH 0 of N]" introduction, which describes the series as a whole.

       Each patch email has a Subject line of "[PATCH M of N] ...",  using  the  first  line  of  the  changeset
       description  as  the  subject  text.   The  message  contains  two  or  three parts. First, the changeset
       description.

       With the -d/--diffstat option, if the diffstat program is installed, the result of  running  diffstat  on
       the patch is inserted.

       Finally, the patch itself, as generated by hg export.

       With  the  -d/--diffstat or --confirm options, you will be presented with a final summary of all messages
       and asked for confirmation before the messages are sent.

       By default the patch is included as text in the email body for  easy  reviewing.  Using  the  -a/--attach
       option  will  instead  create  an attachment for the patch. With -i/--inline an inline attachment will be
       created. You can include a patch both as text in the email body and as a regular or an inline  attachment
       by combining the -a/--attach or -i/--inline with the --body option.

       With -B/--bookmark changesets reachable by the given bookmark are selected.

       With -o/--outgoing, emails will be generated for patches not found in the destination repository (or only
       those which are ancestors of the specified revisions if any are provided)

       With -b/--bundle, changesets are selected as for --outgoing, but  a  single  email  containing  a  binary
       Mercurial bundle as an attachment will be sent. Use the patchbomb.bundletype config option to control the
       bundle type as with hg bundle --type.

       With -m/--mbox, instead of previewing each patchbomb message in a pager or sending the messages directly,
       it  will  create  a  UNIX mailbox file with the patch emails. This mailbox file can be previewed with any
       mail user agent which supports UNIX mbox files.

       With -n/--test, all steps will run, but mail will not be  sent.   You  will  be  prompted  for  an  email
       recipient  address, a subject and an introductory message describing the patches of your patchbomb.  Then
       when all is done, patchbomb messages are displayed.

       In  case  email  sending  fails,  you  will  find  a  backup  of  your  series  introductory  message  in
       .hg/last-email.txt.

       The  default behavior of this command can be customized through configuration. (See hg help patchbomb for
       details)

       Examples:

       hg email -r 3000          # send patch 3000 only
       hg email -r 3000 -r 3001  # send patches 3000 and 3001
       hg email -r 3000:3005     # send patches 3000 through 3005
       hg email 3000             # send patch 3000 (deprecated)

       hg email -o               # send all patches not in default
       hg email -o DEST          # send all patches not in DEST
       hg email -o -r 3000       # send all ancestors of 3000 not in default
       hg email -o -r 3000 DEST  # send all ancestors of 3000 not in DEST

       hg email -B feature       # send all ancestors of feature bookmark

       hg email -b               # send bundle of all patches not in default
       hg email -b DEST          # send bundle of all patches not in DEST
       hg email -b -r 3000       # bundle of all ancestors of 3000 not in default
       hg email -b -r 3000 DEST  # bundle of all ancestors of 3000 not in DEST

       hg email -o -m mbox &&    # generate an mbox file...
         mutt -R -f mbox         # ... and view it with mutt
       hg email -o -m mbox &&    # generate an mbox file ...
         formail -s sendmail \   # ... and use formail to send from the mbox
           -bm -t < mbox         # ... using sendmail

       Before using this command, you will need to enable email in your hgrc. See the [email] section in hgrc(5)
       for details.

       Options:

       -g, --git
              use git extended diff format

       --plain
              omit hg patch header

       -o, --outgoing
              send changes not found in the target repository

       -b, --bundle
              send changes not in target as a binary bundle

       -B,--bookmark <BOOKMARK>
              send changes only reachable by given bookmark

       --bundlename <NAME>
              name of the bundle attachment file (default: bundle)

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              a revision to send

       --force
              run even when remote repository is unrelated (with -b/--bundle)

       --base <REV[+]>
              a base changeset to specify instead of a destination (with -b/--bundle)

       --intro
              send an introduction email for a single patch

       --body send patches as inline message text (default)

       -a, --attach
              send patches as attachments

       -i, --inline
              send patches as inline attachments

       --bcc <EMAIL[+]>
              email addresses of blind carbon copy recipients

       -c,--cc <EMAIL[+]>
              email addresses of copy recipients

       --confirm
              ask for confirmation before sending

       -d, --diffstat
              add diffstat output to messages

       --date <DATE>
              use the given date as the sending date

       --desc <FILE>
              use the given file as the series description

       -f,--from <EMAIL>
              email address of sender

       -n, --test
              print messages that would be sent

       -m,--mbox <FILE>
              write messages to mbox file instead of sending them

       --reply-to <EMAIL[+]>
              email addresses replies should be sent to

       -s,--subject <TEXT>
              subject of first message (intro or single patch)

       --in-reply-to <MSGID>
              message identifier to reply to

       --flag <FLAG[+]>
              flags to add in subject prefixes

       -t,--to <EMAIL[+]>
              email addresses of recipients

       -e,--ssh <CMD>
              specify ssh command to use

       --remotecmd <CMD>
              specify hg command to run on the remote side

       --insecure
              do not verify server certificate (ignoring web.cacerts config)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   phabricator
       simple Phabricator integration (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This  extension  provides  a  phabsend  command  which  sends a stack of changesets to Phabricator, and a
       phabread command which prints a stack of revisions in a format suitable for hg import, and  a  phabupdate
       command to update statuses in batch.

       A  "phabstatus"  view  for  hg  show is  also  provided;  it  displays  status information of Phabricator
       differentials associated with unfinished changesets.

       By default, Phabricator requires Test Plan which might  prevent  some  changeset  from  being  sent.  The
       requirement could be disabled by changing differential.require-test-plan-field config server side.

       Config:

       [phabricator]
       # Phabricator URL
       url = https://phab.example.com/

       # Repo callsign. If a repo has a URL https://$HOST/diffusion/FOO, then its
       # callsign is "FOO".
       callsign = FOO

       # curl command to use. If not set (default), use builtin HTTP library to
       # communicate. If set, use the specified curl command. This could be useful
       # if you need to specify advanced options that is not easily supported by
       # the internal library.
       curlcmd = curl --connect-timeout 2 --retry 3 --silent

       [auth]
       example.schemes = https
       example.prefix = phab.example.com

       # API token. Get it from https://$HOST/conduit/login/
       example.phabtoken = cli-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx

   Commands
   Change import/export
   phabread
       print patches from Phabricator suitable for importing:

       hg phabread DREVSPEC [OPTIONS]

       DREVSPEC could be a Differential Revision identity, like D123, or just the number 123. It could also have
       common operators like +, -, &, (, ) for complex queries. Prefix : could be used to select a stack.

       abandoned, accepted, closed, needsreview, needsrevision could be used to filter patches  by  status.  For
       performance reason, they only represent a subset of non-status selections and cannot be used alone.

       For  example,  :D6+8-(2+D4)  selects  a  stack up to D6, plus D8 and exclude D2 and D4. :D9 & needsreview
       selects "Needs Review" revisions in a stack up to D9.

       If --stack is given, follow dependencies information and read all patches.  It is  equivalent  to  the  :
       operator.

       Options:

       --stack
              read dependencies

       --test-vcr <VALUE>
              Path to a vcr file. If nonexistent, will record a new vcr transcript, otherwise will mock all http
              requests using the specified vcr file. (ADVANCED)

   phabsend
       upload changesets to Phabricator:

       hg phabsend REV [OPTIONS]

       If there are multiple revisions specified, they will be send  as  a  stack  with  a  linear  dependencies
       relationship using the order specified by the revset.

       For  the  first  time uploading changesets, local tags will be created to maintain the association. After
       the first time, phabsend will check obsstore and tags information so it can figure out whether to  update
       an existing Differential Revision, or create a new one.

       If  --amend  is  set,  update  commit messages so they have the Differential Revision URL, remove related
       tags. This is similar to what arcanist will do, and is more desired in author-push workflows.  Otherwise,
       use local tags to record the Differential Revision association.

       The  --confirm option lets you confirm changesets before sending them. You can also add following to your
       configuration file to make it default behaviour:

       [phabsend]
       confirm = true

       phabsend will check obsstore  and  the  above  association  to  decide  whether  to  update  an  existing
       Differential Revision, or create a new one.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              revisions to send

       --amend
              update commit messages (default: True)

       --reviewer <VALUE[+]>
              specify reviewers

       --blocker <VALUE[+]>
              specify blocking reviewers

       -m,--comment <VALUE>
              add a comment to Revisions with new/updated Diffs

       --confirm
              ask for confirmation before sending

       --test-vcr <VALUE>
              Path to a vcr file. If nonexistent, will record a new vcr transcript, otherwise will mock all http
              requests using the specified vcr file. (ADVANCED)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   phabupdate
       update Differential Revision in batch:

       hg phabupdate DREVSPEC [OPTIONS]

       DREVSPEC selects revisions. See hg help phabread for its usage.

       Options:

       --accept
              accept revisions

       --reject
              reject revisions

       --abandon
              abandon revisions

       --reclaim
              reclaim revisions

       -m,--comment <VALUE>
              comment on the last revision

       --test-vcr <VALUE>
              Path to a vcr file. If nonexistent, will record a new vcr transcript, otherwise will mock all http
              requests using the specified vcr file. (ADVANCED)

   Uncategorized commands
   purge
       command to delete untracked files from the working directory

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   purge
       removes files not tracked by Mercurial:

       hg purge [OPTION]... [DIR]...

       Delete  files  not  known  to  Mercurial.  This  is  useful  to  test local and uncommitted changes in an
       otherwise-clean source tree.

       This means that purge will delete the following by default:

       • Unknown files: files marked with "?" by hg status

       • Empty directories: in fact Mercurial ignores directories unless they contain files under source control
         management

       But it will leave untouched:

       • Modified and unmodified tracked files

       • Ignored files (unless --all is specified)

       • New files added to the repository (with hg add)

       The  --files  and  --dirs  options can be used to direct purge to delete only files, only directories, or
       both. If neither option is given, both will be deleted.

       If directories are given on the command line, only files in these directories are considered.

       Be careful with purge, as you could irreversibly delete some files you forgot to add to  the  repository.
       If you only want to print the list of files that this program would delete, use the --print option.

       Options:

       -a, --abort-on-err
              abort if an error occurs

       --all  purge ignored files too

       --dirs purge empty directories

       --files
              purge files

       -p, --print
              print filenames instead of deleting them

       -0, --print0
              end filenames with NUL, for use with xargs (implies -p/--print)

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

          aliases: clean

   rebase
       command to move sets of revisions to a different ancestor

       This extension lets you rebase changesets in an existing Mercurial repository.

       For more information: https://mercurial-scm.org/wiki/RebaseExtension

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   rebase
       move changeset (and descendants) to a different branch:

       hg rebase [-s REV | -b REV] [-d REV] [OPTION]

       Rebase  uses repeated merging to graft changesets from one part of history (the source) onto another (the
       destination). This can be useful for linearizing local changes relative to a master development tree.

       Published commits cannot be rebased (see hg help phases).  To copy commits, see hg help graft.

       If you don't specify a destination changeset (-d/--dest), rebase will use the same logic as  hg  merge to
       pick a destination.  if the current branch contains exactly one other head, the other head is merged with
       by default.  Otherwise, an explicit revision with which to merge with  must  be  provided.   (destination
       changeset is not modified by rebasing, but new changesets are added as its descendants.)

       Here are the ways to select changesets:

          1. Explicitly select them using --rev.

          2. Use --source to select a root changeset and include all of its descendants.

          3. Use  --base  to  select a changeset; rebase will find ancestors and their descendants which are not
             also ancestors of the destination.

          4. If you do not specify any of --rev, --source, or --base, rebase will use --base . as above.

       If --source or --rev is used, special names SRC and ALLSRC can be used in --dest.  Destination  would  be
       calculated per source revision with SRC substituted by that single source revision and ALLSRC substituted
       by all source revisions.

       Rebase will destroy original changesets unless you use --keep.  It will also move your bookmarks (even if
       you do).

       Some  changesets  may  be  dropped  if  they  do not contribute changes (e.g. merges from the destination
       branch).

       Unlike merge, rebase will do nothing if you are at the branch tip of a named branch with two  heads.  You
       will need to explicitly specify source and/or destination.

       If  you  need to use a tool to automate merge/conflict decisions, you can specify one with --tool, see hg
       help merge-tools.  As a caveat: the tool will not be used to mediate when a file was deleted, there is no
       hook presently available for this.

       If  a  rebase  is  interrupted  to  manually  resolve a conflict, it can be continued with --continue/-c,
       aborted with --abort/-a, or stopped with --stop.

       Examples:

       • move "local changes" (current commit back to branching point) to the current branch tip after a pull:

         hg rebase

       • move a single changeset to the stable branch:

         hg rebase -r 5f493448 -d stable

       • splice a commit and all its descendants onto another part of history:

         hg rebase --source c0c3 --dest 4cf9

       • rebase everything on a branch marked by a bookmark onto the default branch:

         hg rebase --base myfeature --dest default

       • collapse a sequence of changes into a single commit:

         hg rebase --collapse -r 1520:1525 -d .

       • move a named branch while preserving its name:

         hg rebase -r "branch(featureX)" -d 1.3 --keepbranches

       • stabilize orphaned changesets so history looks linear:

         hg rebase -r 'orphan()-obsolete()' -d 'first(max((successors(max(roots(ALLSRC) & ::SRC)^)-obsolete())::) + max(::((roots(ALLSRC) & ::SRC)^)-obsolete()))'

       Configuration Options:

       You can make rebase require a destination if you set the following config option:

       [commands]
       rebase.requiredest = True

       By default, rebase will close the transaction after  each  commit.  For  performance  purposes,  you  can
       configure rebase to use a single transaction across the entire rebase. WARNING: This setting introduces a
       significant risk of losing the work you've done in a rebase if the rebase aborts unexpectedly:

       [rebase]
       singletransaction = True

       By default, rebase writes to the working copy, but you can configure  it  to  run  in-memory  for  better
       performance.  When the rebase is not moving the parent(s) of the working copy (AKA the "currently checked
       out changesets"), this may also allow it to run even if the working copy is dirty:

       [rebase]
       experimental.inmemory = True

       Return Values:

       Returns 0 on success, 1 if nothing to rebase or there are unresolved conflicts.

       Options:

       -s,--source <REV>
              rebase the specified changeset and descendants

       -b,--base <REV>
              rebase everything from branching point of specified changeset

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              rebase these revisions

       -d,--dest <REV>
              rebase onto the specified changeset

       --collapse
              collapse the rebased changesets

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as collapse commit message

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read collapse commit message from file

       -k, --keep
              keep original changesets

       --keepbranches
              keep original branch names

       -D, --detach
              (DEPRECATED)

       -i, --interactive
              (DEPRECATED)

       -t,--tool <VALUE>
              specify merge tool

       --stop stop interrupted rebase

       -c, --continue
              continue an interrupted rebase

       -a, --abort
              abort an interrupted rebase

       --auto-orphans <VALUE>
              automatically rebase orphan revisions in the specified revset (EXPERIMENTAL)

       -n, --dry-run
              do not perform actions, just print output

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

       --confirm
              ask before applying actions

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   record
       commands to interactively select changes for commit/qrefresh (DEPRECATED)

       The feature provided by this extension has been moved into core Mercurial as hg commit --interactive.

   Commands
   Change creation
   qrecord
       interactively record a new patch:

       hg qrecord [OPTION]... PATCH [FILE]...

       See hg help qnew & hg help record for more information and usage.

   record
       interactively select changes to commit:

       hg record [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       If a list of files is omitted, all changes reported by hg status will be candidates for recording.

       See hg help dates for a list of formats valid for -d/--date.

       If using the text interface (see hg help config), you will be prompted for whether to record  changes  to
       each  modified  file,  and  for  files with multiple changes, for each change to use. For each query, the
       following responses are possible:

       y - record this change
       n - skip this change
       e - edit this change manually

       s - skip remaining changes to this file
       f - record remaining changes to this file

       d - done, skip remaining changes and files
       a - record all changes to all remaining files
       q - quit, recording no changes

       ? - display help

       This command is not available when committing a merge.

       Options:

       -A, --addremove
              mark new/missing files as added/removed before committing

       --close-branch
              mark a branch head as closed

       --amend
              amend the parent of the working directory

       -s, --secret
              use the secret phase for committing

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       --force-close-branch
              forcibly close branch from a non-head changeset (ADVANCED)

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -S, --subrepos
              recurse into subrepositories

       -w, --ignore-all-space
              ignore white space when comparing lines

       -b, --ignore-space-change
              ignore changes in the amount of white space

       -B, --ignore-blank-lines
              ignore changes whose lines are all blank

       -Z, --ignore-space-at-eol
              ignore changes in whitespace at EOL

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   releasenotes
       generate release notes from commit messages (EXPERIMENTAL)

       It is common to maintain files detailing changes in a project between releases. Maintaining  these  files
       can  be  difficult  and time consuming.  The hg releasenotes command provided by this extension makes the
       process simpler by automating it.

   Commands
   Change navigation
   releasenotes
       parse release notes from commit messages into an output file:

       hg releasenotes [-r REV] [-c] FILE

       Given an output file and set of revisions, this command will parse commit messages for release notes then
       add them to the output file.

       Release notes are defined in commit messages as ReStructuredText directives. These have the form:

       .. directive:: title

          content

       Each  directive  maps  to  an  output  section  in  a  generated  release  notes  file,  which  itself is
       ReStructuredText. For example, the .. feature:: directive would map to a New Features section.

       Release note directives can be either short-form or long-form. In short- form, title is omitted  and  the
       release  note  is rendered as a bullet list. In long form, a sub-section with the title title is added to
       the section.

       The FILE argument controls the output file to write gathered release notes to. The format of the file is:

       Section 1
       =========

       ...

       Section 2
       =========

       ...

       Only sections with defined release notes are emitted.

       If a section only has short-form notes, it will consist of bullet list:

       Section
       =======

       * Release note 1
       * Release note 2

       If a section has long-form notes, sub-sections will be emitted:

       Section
       =======

       Note 1 Title
       ------------

       Description of the first long-form note.

       Note 2 Title
       ------------

       Description of the second long-form note.

       If the FILE argument points to an existing file, that file will be parsed for release  notes  having  the
       format  that  would  be  generated  by this command. The notes from the processed commit messages will be
       merged into this parsed set.

       During release notes merging:

       • Duplicate items are automatically ignored

       • Items that are different are automatically ignored if the similarity is greater than a threshold.

       This means that the release notes file can be updated independently from this command and changes  should
       not  be  lost  when  running  this  command  on that file. A particular use case for this is to tweak the
       wording of a release note after it has been added to the release notes file.

       The -c/--check option checks the commit message for invalid admonitions.

       The -l/--list option, presents the user with a list of existing available admonitions  along  with  their
       title. This also includes the custom admonitions (if any).

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revisions to process for release notes

       -c, --check
              checks for validity of admonitions (if any)

       -l, --list
              list the available admonitions with their title

   Uncategorized commands
   relink
       recreates hardlinks between repository clones

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   relink
       recreate hardlinks between two repositories:

       hg relink [ORIGIN]

       When repositories are cloned locally, their data files will be hardlinked so that they only use the space
       of a single repository.

       Unfortunately, subsequent pulls into either repository will break hardlinks for any files touched by  the
       new changesets, even if both repositories end up pulling the same changes.

       Similarly, passing --rev to "hg clone" will fail to use any hardlinks, falling back to a complete copy of
       the source repository.

       This command lets you recreate those hardlinks and reclaim that wasted space.

       This repository will be relinked to share space with ORIGIN, which must be on the  same  local  disk.  If
       ORIGIN is omitted, looks for "default-relink", then "default", in [paths].

       Do  not  attempt  any read operations on this repository while the command is running. (Both repositories
       will be locked against writes.)

   remotefilelog
       remotefilelog causes Mercurial to lazilly fetch file contents (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This extension is HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL. There are NO BACKWARDS COMPATIBILITY GUARANTEES. This  means  that
       repositories   created  with  this  extension  may  only  be  usable  with  the  exact  version  of  this
       extension/Mercurial that was used. The extension attempts to enforce this in order to prevent  repository
       corruption.

       remotefilelog  works  by  fetching  file contents lazily and storing them in a cache on the client rather
       than in revlogs. This allows enormous histories to be transferred only partially, making them  easier  to
       operate on.

       Configs:

          packs.maxchainlen specifies the maximum delta chain length in pack files

          packs.maxpacksize specifies the maximum pack file size

          packs.maxpackfilecount specifies the maximum number of packs in the

                 shared cache (trees only for now)

          remotefilelog.backgroundprefetch runs prefetch in background when True

          remotefilelog.bgprefetchrevs specifies revisions to fetch on commit and

                 update, and on other commands that use them. Different from pullprefetch.

          remotefilelog.gcrepack does garbage collection during repack when True

          remotefilelog.nodettl specifies maximum TTL of a node in seconds before

                 it is garbage collected

          remotefilelog.repackonhggc runs repack on hg gc when True

          remotefilelog.prefetchdays specifies the maximum age of a commit in

                 days after which it is no longer prefetched.

          remotefilelog.prefetchdelay specifies delay between background

                 prefetches in seconds after operations that change the working copy parent

          remotefilelog.data.gencountlimit constraints the minimum number of data

                 pack  files  required  to  be considered part of a generation. In particular, minimum number of
                 packs files > gencountlimit.

          remotefilelog.data.generations list for specifying the lower bound of

                 each generation of the data pack files. For example, list ['100MB','1MB'] or  ['1MB',  '100MB']
                 will lead to three generations: [0, 1MB), [ 1MB, 100MB) and [100MB, infinity).

          remotefilelog.data.maxrepackpacks the maximum number of pack files to

                 include in an incremental data repack.

          remotefilelog.data.repackmaxpacksize the maximum size of a pack file for

                 it to be considered for an incremental data repack.

          remotefilelog.data.repacksizelimit the maximum total size of pack files

                 to include in an incremental data repack.

          remotefilelog.history.gencountlimit constraints the minimum number of

                 history  pack  files  required  to  be  considered part of a generation. In particular, minimum
                 number of packs files > gencountlimit.

          remotefilelog.history.generations list for specifying the lower bound of

                 each generation of the history pack files. For example,  list  [  '100MB',  '1MB']  or  ['1MB',
                 '100MB'] will lead to three generations: [ 0, 1MB), [1MB, 100MB) and [100MB, infinity).

          remotefilelog.history.maxrepackpacks the maximum number of pack files to

                 include in an incremental history repack.

          remotefilelog.history.repackmaxpacksize the maximum size of a pack file

                 for it to be considered for an incremental history repack.

          remotefilelog.history.repacksizelimit the maximum total size of pack

                 files to include in an incremental history repack.

          remotefilelog.backgroundrepack automatically consolidate packs in the

                 background

          remotefilelog.cachepath path to cache

          remotefilelog.cachegroup if set, make cache directory sgid to this

                 group

          remotefilelog.cacheprocess binary to invoke for fetching file data

          remotefilelog.debug turn on remotefilelog-specific debug output

          remotefilelog.excludepattern pattern of files to exclude from pulls

          remotefilelog.includepattern pattern of files to include in pulls

          remotefilelog.fetchwarning: message to print when too many

                 single-file fetches occur

          remotefilelog.getfilesstep number of files to request in a single RPC

          remotefilelog.getfilestype if set to 'threaded' use threads to fetch

                 files, otherwise use optimistic fetching

          remotefilelog.pullprefetch revset for selecting files that should be

                 eagerly downloaded rather than lazily

          remotefilelog.reponame name of the repo. If set, used to partition

                 data from other repos in a shared store.

          remotefilelog.server if true, enable server-side functionality

          remotefilelog.servercachepath path for caching blobs on the server

          remotefilelog.serverexpiration number of days to keep cached server

                 blobs

          remotefilelog.validatecache if set, check cache entries for corruption

                 before returning blobs

          remotefilelog.validatecachelog if set, check cache entries for

                 corruption before returning metadata

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   prefetch
       prefetch file revisions from the server:

       hg prefetch [OPTIONS] [FILE...]

       Prefetchs  file revisions for the specified revs and stores them in the local remotefilelog cache.  If no
       rev is specified, the  default  rev  is  used  which  is  the  union  of  dot,  draft,  pullprefetch  and
       bgprefetchrev.  File names or patterns can be used to limit which files are downloaded.

       Return 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              prefetch the specified revisions

       --repack
              run repack after prefetch

       -b,--base <VALUE>
              rev that is assumed to already be local

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   Uncategorized commands
   gc
       garbage collect the client and server filelog caches:

       hg gc [REPO...]

       garbage collect the client and server filelog caches

   repack
       hg repack [OPTIONS]

       Options:

       --background
              run in a background process

       --incremental
              do an incremental repack

       --packsonly
              only repack packs (skip loose objects)

   verifyremotefilelog
       hg verifyremotefilelogs <directory>

       Options:

       -d, --decompress
              decompress the filelogs first

   remotenames
          showing remotebookmarks and remotebranches in UI (EXPERIMENTAL)

       By default both remotebookmarks and remotebranches are turned on. Config knob to control the individually
       are as follows.

       Config options to tweak the default behaviour:

       remotenames.bookmarks
              Boolean value to enable or disable showing of remotebookmarks (default: True)

       remotenames.branches
              Boolean value to enable or disable showing of remotebranches (default: True)

       remotenames.hoistedpeer
              Name of the peer whose remotebookmarks should be hoisted into the  top-level  namespace  (default:
              'default')

   schemes
       extend schemes with shortcuts to repository swarms

       This  extension  allows you to specify shortcuts for parent URLs with a lot of repositories to act like a
       scheme, for example:

       [schemes]
       py = http://code.python.org/hg/

       After that you can use it like:

       hg clone py://trunk/

       Additionally there is support for some more complex schemas, for example used by Google Code:

       [schemes]
       gcode = http://{1}.googlecode.com/hg/

       The syntax is taken from Mercurial templates, and you have unlimited number of variables,  starting  with
       {1}  and  continuing with {2}, {3} and so on. This variables will receive parts of URL supplied, split by
       /. Anything not specified as {part} will be just appended to an URL.

       For convenience, the extension adds these schemes by default:

       [schemes]
       py = http://hg.python.org/
       bb = https://bitbucket.org/
       bb+ssh = ssh://hg@bitbucket.org/
       gcode = https://{1}.googlecode.com/hg/
       kiln = https://{1}.kilnhg.com/Repo/

       You can override a predefined scheme by defining a new scheme with the same name.

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   share
       share a common history between several working directories

   Automatic Pooled Storage for Clones
       When this extension is active, hg clone can be configured  to  automatically  share/pool  storage  across
       multiple  clones.  This  mode effectively converts hg clone to hg clone + hg share.  The benefit of using
       this mode is the automatic management of store paths and intelligent pooling of related repositories.

       The following share. config options influence this feature:

       share.pool

              Filesystem path where  shared  repository  data  will  be  stored.  When  defined,  hg  clone will
              automatically use shared repository storage instead of creating a store inside each clone.

       share.poolnaming

              How directory names in share.pool are constructed.

              "identity"  means  the  name  is derived from the first changeset in the repository. In this mode,
              different remotes share storage if their root/initial changeset is identical. In  this  mode,  the
              local shared repository is an aggregate of all encountered remote repositories.

              "remote" means the name is derived from the source repository's path or URL. In this mode, storage
              is only shared if the path or  URL  requested  in  the  hg  clone command  matches  exactly  to  a
              repository that was cloned before.

              The default naming mode is "identity".

   Commands
   Repository creation
   share
       create a new shared repository:

       hg share [-U] [-B] SOURCE [DEST]

       Initialize a new repository and working directory that shares its history (and optionally bookmarks) with
       another repository.

       Note   using rollback or extensions that destroy/modify history (mq, rebase, etc.) can cause considerable
              confusion  with  shared  clones.  In particular, if two shared clones are both updated to the same
              changeset, and one of them destroys that changeset with rollback, the other  clone  will  suddenly
              stop  working:  all  operations  will fail with "abort: working directory has unknown parent". The
              only known workaround is to use debugsetparents on the broken clone to reset  it  to  a  changeset
              that still exists.

       Options:

       -U, --noupdate
              do not create a working directory

       -B, --bookmarks
              also share bookmarks

       --relative
              point to source using a relative path

   Repository maintenance
   unshare
       convert a shared repository to a normal one:

       hg unshare

       Copy the store data to the repo and remove the sharedpath data.

   show
       unified command to show various repository information (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This   extension  provides  the  hg  show command,  which  provides  a  central  command  for  displaying
       commonly-accessed repository data and views of that data.

       The following config options can influence operation.

   commands
       show.aliasprefix

              List of strings that will register aliases for views. e.g. s will effectively set  config  options
              alias.s<view> = show <view> for all views. i.e. hg swork would execute hg show work.

              Aliases that would conflict with existing registrations will not be performed.

   Commands
   Change navigation
   show
       show various repository information:

       hg show VIEW

       A requested view of repository data is displayed.

       If no view is requested, the list of available views is shown and the command aborts.

       Note   There  are no backwards compatibility guarantees for the output of this command. Output may change
              in any future Mercurial release.

              Consumers wanting stable command output should specify a template via -T/--template.

       List of available views:

       bookmarks   bookmarks and their associated changeset

       stack       current line of work

       work        changesets that aren't finished

       Options:

       -T,--template <TEMPLATE>
              display with template

   sparse
       allow sparse checkouts of the working directory (EXPERIMENTAL)

       (This extension is not yet protected by backwards compatibility  guarantees.  Any  aspect  may  break  in
       future releases until this notice is removed.)

       This  extension  allows the working directory to only consist of a subset of files for the revision. This
       allows specific files or directories to be explicitly included or excluded.  Many  repository  operations
       have performance proportional to the number of files in the working directory. So only realizing a subset
       of files in the working directory can improve performance.

   Sparse Config Files
       The set of files that are part of a sparse checkout are defined by a sparse config file. The file defines
       3  things: includes (files to include in the sparse checkout), excludes (files to exclude from the sparse
       checkout), and profiles (links to other config files).

       The file format is newline delimited. Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored.

       Lines beginning with  %include  ``  denote  another  sparse  config  file  to  include.  e.g.  ``%include
       tests.sparse. The filename is relative to the repository root.

       The  special  lines  [include]  and  [exclude]  denote the section for includes and excludes that follow,
       respectively. It is illegal to have [include] after [exclude].

       Non-special lines resemble file patterns to be added to either includes or excludes. The syntax of  these
       lines  is documented by hg help patterns.  Patterns are interpreted as glob: by default and match against
       the root of the repository.

       Exclusion patterns take precedence over inclusion patterns. So even if a file is explicitly included,  an
       [exclude] entry can remove it.

       For example, say you have a repository with 3 directories, frontend/, backend/, and tools/. frontend/ and
       backend/ correspond to different projects and it is uncommon for someone working on one to need the files
       for  the  other.  But  tools/  contains  files shared between both projects. Your sparse config files may
       resemble:

       # frontend.sparse
       frontend/**
       tools/**

       # backend.sparse
       backend/**
       tools/**

       Say the backend grows in size. Or there's a directory with thousands of files you wish  to  exclude.  You
       can modify the profile to exclude certain files:

       [include]
       backend/**
       tools/**

       [exclude]
       tools/tests/**

   Commands
   Uncategorized commands
   split
       command to split a changeset into smaller ones (EXPERIMENTAL)

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   split
       split a changeset into smaller ones:

       hg split [--no-rebase] [[-r] REV]

       Repeatedly  prompt  changes  and  commit  message  for  new changesets until there is nothing left in the
       original changeset.

       If --rev was not given, split the working directory parent.

       By default, rebase connected non-obsoleted descendants onto the new changeset. Use --no-rebase  to  avoid
       the rebase.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV>
              revision to split

       --rebase
              rebase descendants after split (default: True)

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

   sqlitestore
       store repository data in SQLite (EXPERIMENTAL)

       The sqlitestore extension enables the storage of repository data in SQLite.

       This  extension  is HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL. There are NO BACKWARDS COMPATIBILITY GUARANTEES. This means that
       repositories  created  with  this  extension  may  only  be  usable  with  the  exact  version  of   this
       extension/Mercurial  that was used. The extension attempts to enforce this in order to prevent repository
       corruption.

       In addition, several features are not yet supported or have known bugs:

       • Only some data is stored in SQLite. Changeset, manifest, and other repository data is not yet stored in
         SQLite.

       • Transactions  are  not  robust.  If  the  process  is  aborted  at  the  right  time during transaction
         close/rollback, the repository could be in an inconsistent state. This problem will diminish  once  all
         repository data is tracked by SQLite.

       • Bundle  repositories  do  not  work  (the ability to use e.g.  hg -R <bundle-file> log to automatically
         overlay a bundle on top of the existing repository).

       • Various other features don't work.

       This extension should work for basic clone/pull, update, and commit workflows.   Some  history  rewriting
       operations may fail due to lack of support for bundle repositories.

       To use, activate the extension and set the storage.new-repo-backend config option to sqlite to enable new
       repositories to use SQLite for storage.

   strip
       strip changesets and their descendants from history

       This extension allows you to strip changesets and all their descendants  from  the  repository.  See  the
       command help for details.

   Commands
   Repository maintenance
   strip
       strip changesets and all their descendants from the repository:

       hg strip [-k] [-f] [-B bookmark] [-r] REV...

       The  strip  command  removes the specified changesets and all their descendants. If the working directory
       has uncommitted changes, the operation is aborted unless the --force flag  is  supplied,  in  which  case
       changes will be discarded.

       If  a  parent  of  the  working  directory  is stripped, then the working directory will automatically be
       updated to the most recent available ancestor of the stripped parent after the operation completes.

       Any stripped changesets are stored in .hg/strip-backup as a  bundle  (see  hg  help  bundle and  hg  help
       unbundle).  They  can  be  restored  by  running hg unbundle .hg/strip-backup/BUNDLE, where BUNDLE is the
       bundle file created by the strip. Note that the local revision numbers will in general be different after
       the restore.

       Use the --no-backup option to discard the backup bundle once the operation completes.

       Strip  is not a history-rewriting operation and can be used on changesets in the public phase. But if the
       stripped changesets have been pushed to a remote repository you will likely pull them again.

       Return 0 on success.

       Options:

       -r,--rev <REV[+]>
              strip specified revision (optional, can specify revisions without this option)

       -f, --force
              force removal of changesets, discard uncommitted changes (no backup)

       --no-backup
              do not save backup bundle

       --nobackup
              do not save backup bundle (DEPRECATED)

       -n     ignored  (DEPRECATED)

       -k, --keep
              do not modify working directory during strip

       -B,--bookmark <BOOKMARK[+]>
              remove revs only reachable from given bookmark

       --soft simply drop changesets from visible history (EXPERIMENTAL)

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   transplant
       command to transplant changesets from another branch

       This extension allows you  to  transplant  changes  to  another  parent  revision,  possibly  in  another
       repository. The transplant is done using 'diff' patches.

       Transplanted  patches  are  recorded in .hg/transplant/transplants, as a map from a changeset hash to its
       hash in the source repository.

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   transplant
       transplant changesets from another branch:

       hg transplant [-s REPO] [-b BRANCH [-a]] [-p REV] [-m REV] [REV]...

       Selected changesets will be applied on top of the current working directory with the log of the  original
       changeset. The changesets are copied and will thus appear twice in the history with different identities.

       Consider  using  the  graft  command if everything is inside the same repository - it will use merges and
       will usually give a better result.  Use the rebase extension if the changesets are  unpublished  and  you
       want to move them instead of copying them.

       If --log is specified, log messages will have a comment appended of the form:

       (transplanted from CHANGESETHASH)

       You  can  rewrite  the changelog message with the --filter option.  Its argument will be invoked with the
       current changelog message as $1 and the patch as $2.

       --source/-s specifies another repository to use for selecting changesets, just as if it  temporarily  had
       been  pulled.   If  --branch/-b  is  specified, these revisions will be used as heads when deciding which
       changesets to transplant, just as if only these revisions had been pulled.  If --all/-a is specified, all
       the revisions up to the heads specified with --branch will be transplanted.

       Example:

       • transplant all changes up to REV on top of your current revision:

         hg transplant --branch REV --all

       You can optionally mark selected transplanted changesets as merge changesets. You will not be prompted to
       transplant any ancestors of a merged transplant, and you can merge descendants of them  normally  instead
       of transplanting them.

       Merge  changesets  may  be  transplanted directly by specifying the proper parent changeset by calling hg
       transplant --parent.

       If no merges or revisions are provided, hg transplant will start an interactive changeset browser.

       If a changeset application fails, you can fix the merge by hand and then resume where  you  left  off  by
       calling hg transplant --continue/-c.

       Options:

       -s,--source <REPO>
              transplant changesets from REPO

       -b,--branch <REV[+]>
              use this source changeset as head

       -a, --all
              pull all changesets up to the --branch revisions

       -p,--prune <REV[+]>
              skip over REV

       -m,--merge <REV[+]>
              merge at REV

       --parent <REV>
              parent to choose when transplanting merge

       -e, --edit
              invoke editor on commit messages

       --log  append transplant info to log message

       --stop stop interrupted transplant

       -c, --continue
              continue last transplant session after fixing conflicts

       --filter <CMD>
              filter changesets through command

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   uncommit
       uncommit part or all of a local changeset (EXPERIMENTAL)

       This  command  undoes  the  effect  of  a local commit, returning the affected files to their uncommitted
       state. This means that files modified, added or removed in the changeset will be left unchanged,  and  so
       will remain modified, added and removed in the working directory.

   Commands
   Change manipulation
   unamend
       undo the most recent amend operation on a current changeset:

       hg unamend

       This command will roll back to the previous version of a changeset, leaving working directory in state in
       which it was before running hg amend (e.g. files modified as part of an amend will be marked as  modified
       hg status)

   uncommit
       uncommit part or all of a local changeset:

       hg uncommit [OPTION]... [FILE]...

       This  command  undoes  the  effect  of  a local commit, returning the affected files to their uncommitted
       state. This means that files modified or deleted in the changeset will be left  unchanged,  and  so  will
       remain modified in the working directory.

       If no files are specified, the commit will be pruned, unless --keep is given.

       Options:

       --keep allow an empty commit after uncommitting

       --allow-dirty-working-copy
              allow uncommit with outstanding changes

       -n,--note <TEXT>
              store a note on uncommit

       -I,--include <PATTERN[+]>
              include names matching the given patterns

       -X,--exclude <PATTERN[+]>
              exclude names matching the given patterns

       -m,--message <TEXT>
              use text as commit message

       -l,--logfile <FILE>
              read commit message from file

       -d,--date <DATE>
              record the specified date as commit date

       -u,--user <USER>
              record the specified user as committer

       -D, --currentdate
              record the current date as commit date

       -U, --currentuser
              record the current user as committer

       [+] marked option can be specified multiple times

   win32mbcs
       allow the use of MBCS paths with problematic encodings

       Some  MBCS  encodings are not good for some path operations (i.e.  splitting path, case conversion, etc.)
       with its encoded bytes. We call such a encoding (i.e. shift_jis  and  big5)  as  "problematic  encoding".
       This extension can be used to fix the issue with those encodings by wrapping some functions to convert to
       Unicode string before path operation.

       This extension is useful for:

       • Japanese Windows users using shift_jis encoding.

       • Chinese Windows users using big5 encoding.

       • All users who use a repository with one of problematic encodings on case-insensitive file system.

       This extension is not needed for:

       • Any user who use only ASCII chars in path.

       • Any user who do not use any of problematic encodings.

       Note that there are some limitations on using this extension:

       • You should use single encoding in one repository.

       • If the repository path ends with 0x5c, .hg/hgrc cannot be read.

       • win32mbcs is not compatible with fixutf8 extension.

       By default, win32mbcs uses encoding.encoding decided by Mercurial.   You  can  specify  the  encoding  by
       config option:

       [win32mbcs]
       encoding = sjis

       It is useful for the users who want to commit with UTF-8 log message.

   win32text
       perform automatic newline conversion (DEPRECATED)

          Deprecation: The win32text extension requires each user to configure the extension again and again for
          each clone since the configuration is not copied when cloning.

          We have therefore made the eol as an alternative. The eol uses  a  version  controlled  file  for  its
          configuration and each clone will therefore use the right settings from the start.

       To perform automatic newline conversion, use:

       [extensions]
       win32text =
       [encode]
       ** = cleverencode:
       # or ** = macencode:

       [decode]
       ** = cleverdecode:
       # or ** = macdecode:

       If not doing conversion, to make sure you do not commit CRLF/CR by accident:

       [hooks]
       pretxncommit.crlf = python:hgext.win32text.forbidcrlf
       # or pretxncommit.cr = python:hgext.win32text.forbidcr

       To do the same check on a server to prevent CRLF/CR from being pushed or pulled:

       [hooks]
       pretxnchangegroup.crlf = python:hgext.win32text.forbidcrlf
       # or pretxnchangegroup.cr = python:hgext.win32text.forbidcr

   zeroconf
       discover and advertise repositories on the local network

       The zeroconf extension will advertise hg serve instances over DNS-SD so that they can be discovered using
       the hg paths command without knowing the server's IP address.

       To allow other people to discover your repository using run hg serve in your repository:

       $ cd test
       $ hg serve

       You can discover Zeroconf-enabled repositories by running hg paths:

       $ hg paths
       zc-test = http://example.com:8000/test

FILES

       /etc/mercurial/hgrc, $HOME/.hgrc, .hg/hgrc

              This file contains defaults and configuration. Values in .hg/hgrc override those  in  $HOME/.hgrc,
              and these override settings made in the global /etc/mercurial/hgrc configuration.  See hgrc(5) for
              details of the contents and format of these files.

       .hgignore

              This file contains regular expressions (one per line) that describe  file  names  that  should  be
              ignored by hg. For details, see hgignore(5).

       .hgsub

              This  file  defines  the  locations  of  all  subrepositories,  and  tells where the subrepository
              checkouts came from. For details, see hg help subrepos.

       .hgsubstate

              This file is where Mercurial stores all nested repository states. NB:  This  file  should  not  be
              edited manually.

       .hgtags

              This file contains changeset hash values and text tag names (one of each separated by spaces) that
              correspond to tagged versions of the repository contents. The file content is encoded using UTF-8.

       .hg/last-message.txt

              This file is used by hg commit to store a backup of the commit message in case the commit fails.

       .hg/localtags

              This file can be used to define local tags which are  not  shared  among  repositories.  The  file
              format is the same as for .hgtags, but it is encoded using the local system encoding.

       Some commands (e.g. revert) produce backup files ending in .orig, if the .orig file already exists and is
       not tracked by Mercurial, it will be overwritten.

BUGS

       Probably lots, please post them to the mailing list (see Resources below) when you find them.

SEE ALSO

       hgignore(5), hgrc(5)

AUTHOR

       Written by Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>

RESOURCES

       Main Web Site: https://mercurial-scm.org/

       Source code repository: https://www.mercurial-scm.org/repo/hg

       Mailing list: https://www.mercurial-scm.org/mailman/listinfo/mercurial/

COPYING

       Copyright (C) 2005-2020 Matt Mackall.  Free use of this software is granted under the terms  of  the  GNU
       General Public License version 2 or any later version.

AUTHOR

       Matt Mackall <mpm@selenic.com>

       Organization: Mercurial

                                                                                                           HG(1)